๐ต๏ธโโ๏ธ The Middle Temple Murder | A Gripping Mystery by J. S. Fletcher ๐
Welcome to Storytime Haven. Today, we delve into the intriguing world of crime and mystery with ‘The Middle Temple Murder’ by J. S. Fletcher. This classic detective novel takes us to London, where a puzzling murder unfolds, and the quest for truth becomes a race against time. Follow the trail of clues as our protagonist, reporter Spargo, gets entangled in a web of secrets, suspects, and twists that challenge everything he thought he knew. Settle in, as we embark on a gripping journey through the heart of this timeless mystery. Chapter 1 – The Scrap of Grey Paper. As a rule, Spargo left the _Watchman_ office at two oโclock. The paper had then gone to press. There was nothing for him, recently promoted to a sub-editorship, to do after he had passed the column for which he was responsible; as a matter of fact he could have gone home before the machines began their clatter. But he generally hung about, trifling, until two oโclock came. On this occasion, the morning of the 22nd of June, 1912, he stopped longer than usual, chatting with Hacket, who had charge of the foreign news, and who began telling him about a telegram which had just come through from Durazzo. What Hacket had to tell was interesting: Spargo lingered to hear all about it, and to discuss it. Altogether it was well beyond half-past two when he went out of the office, unconsciously puffing away from him as he reached the threshold the last breath of the atmosphere in which he had spent his midnight. In Fleet Street the air was fresh, almost to sweetness, and the first grey of the coming dawn was breaking faintly around the high silence of St. Paulโs. Spargo lived in Bloomsbury, on the west side of Russell Square. Every night and every morning he walked to and from the _Watchman_ office by the same routeโSouthampton Row, Kingsway, the Strand, Fleet Street. He came to know several faces, especially amongst the police; he formed the habit of exchanging greetings with various officers whom he encountered at regular points as he went slowly homewards, smoking his pipe. And on this morning, as he drew near to Middle Temple Lane, he saw a policeman whom he knew, one Driscoll, standing at the entrance, looking about him. Further away another policeman appeared, sauntering. Driscoll raised an arm and signalled; then, turning, he saw Spargo. He moved a step or two towards him. Spargo saw news in his face. โWhat is it?โ asked Spargo. Driscoll jerked a thumb over his shoulder, towards the partly open door of the lane. Within, Spargo saw a man hastily donning a waistcoat and jacket. โHe says,โ answered Driscoll, โhim, thereโthe porterโthat thereโs a man lying in one of them entries down the lane, and he thinks heโs dead. Likewise, he thinks heโs murdered.โ Spargo echoed the word. โBut what makes him think that?โ he asked, peeping with curiosity beyond Driscollโs burly form. โWhy?โ โHe says thereโs blood about him,โ answered Driscoll. He turned and glanced at the oncoming constable, and then turned again to Spargo. โYouโre a newspaper man, sir?โ he suggested. โI am,โ replied Spargo. โYouโd better walk down with us,โ said Driscoll, with a grin. โThereโll be something to write pieces in the paper about. At least, there may be.โ Spargo made no answer. He continued to look down the lane, wondering what secret it held, until the other policeman came up. At the same moment the porter, now fully clothed, came out. โCome on!โ he said shortly. โIโll show you.โ Driscoll murmured a word or two to the newly-arrived constable, and then turned to the porter. โHow came you to find him, then?โ he asked The porter jerked his head at the door which they were leaving. โI heard that door slam,โ he replied, irritably, as if the fact which he mentioned caused him offence. โI know I did! So I got up to look around. Thenโwell, I saw that!โ He raised a hand, pointing down the lane. The three men followed his outstretched finger. And Spargo then saw a manโs foot, booted, grey-socked, protruding from an entry on the left hand. โSticking out there, just as you see it now,โ said the porter. โI ainโt touched it. And soโโ He paused and made a grimace as if at the memory of some unpleasant thing. Driscoll nodded comprehendingly. โAnd so you went along and looked?โ he suggested. โJust soโjust to see who it belonged to, as it might be.โ โJust to seeโwhat there was to see,โ agreed the porter. โThen I saw there was blood. And thenโwell, I made up the lane to tell one of you chaps.โ โBest thing you could have done,โ said Driscoll. โWell, now thenโโ The little procession came to a halt at the entry. The entry was a cold and formal thing of itself; not a nice place to lie dead in, having glazed white tiles for its walls and concrete for its flooring; something about its appearance in that grey morning air suggested to Spargo the idea of a mortuary. And that the man whose foot projected over the step was dead he had no doubt: the limpness of his pose certified to it. For a moment none of the four men moved or spoke. The two policemen unconsciously stuck their thumbs in their belts and made play with their fingers; the porter rubbed his chin thoughtfullyโSpargo remembered afterwards the rasping sound of this action; he himself put his hands in his pockets and began to jingle his money and his keys. Each man had his own thoughts as he contemplated the piece of human wreckage which lay before him. โYouโll notice,โ suddenly observed Driscoll, speaking in a hushed voice, โYouโll notice that heโs lying there in a queer wayโsame as ifโas if heโd been put there. Sort of propped up against that wall, at first, and had slid down, like. โ Spargo was taking in all the details with a professional eye. He saw at his feet the body of an elderly man; the face was turned away from him, crushed in against the glaze of the wall, but he judged the man to be elderly because of grey hair and whitening whisker; it was clothed in a good, well-made suit of grey check clothโtweedโand the boots were good: so, too, was the linen cuff which projected from the sleeve that hung so limply. One leg was half doubled under the body; the other was stretched straight out across the threshold; the trunk was twisted to the wall. Over the white glaze of the tiles against which it and the shoulder towards which it had sunk were crushed there were gouts and stains of blood. And Driscoll, taking a hand out of his belt, pointed a finger at them. โSeems to me,โ he said, slowly, โseems to me as how heโs been struck down from behind as he came out of here. That bloodโs from his noseโgushed out as he fell. What do you say, Jim?โ The other policeman coughed. โBetter get the inspector here,โ he said. โAnd the doctor and the ambulance. Deadโainโt he?โ Driscoll bent down and put a thumb on the hand which lay on the pavement. โAs ever they make ’em,โ he remarked laconically. โAnd stiff, too. Well, hurry up, Jim!โ Spargo waited until the inspector arrived; waited until the hand-ambulance came. More policemen came with it; they moved the body for transference to the mortuary, and Spargo then saw the dead manโs face. He looked long and steadily at it while the police arranged the limbs, wondering all the time who it was that he gazed at, how he came to that end, what was the object of his murderer, and many other things. There was some professionalism in Spargoโs curiosity, but there was also a natural dislike that a fellow-being should have been so unceremoniously smitten out of the world. There was nothing very remarkable about the dead manโs face. It was that of a man of apparently sixty to sixty-five years of age; plain, even homely of feature, clean-shaven, except for a fringe of white whisker, trimmed, after an old-fashioned pattern, between the ear and the point of the jaw. The only remarkable thing about it was that it was much lined and seamed; the wrinkles were many and deep around the corners of the lips and the angles of the eyes; this man, you would have said to yourself, has led a hard life and weathered storm, mental as well as physical. Driscoll nudged Spargo with a turn of his elbow. He gave him a wink. โBetter come down to the dead-house,โ he muttered confidentially. โWhy?โ asked Spargo. โTheyโll go through him,โ whispered Driscoll. โSearch him, dโye see? Then youโll get to know all about him, and so on. Help to write that piece in the paper, eh?โ Spargo hesitated. He had had a stiff nightโs work, and until his encounter with Driscoll he had cherished warm anticipation of the meal which would be laid out for him at his rooms, and of the bed into which he would subsequently tumble. Besides, a telephone message would send a man from the _Watchman_ to the mortuary. This sort of thing was not in his line now, nowโ โYouโll be for getting one oโ them big play-cards out with something about a mystery on it,โ suggested Driscoll. โYou never know what lies at the bottom oโ these affairs, no more you donโt.โ That last observation decided Spargo; moreover, the old instinct for getting news began to assert itself. โAll right,โ he said. โIโll go along with you.โ And re-lighting his pipe he followed the little cortรจge through the streets, still deserted and quiet, and as he walked behind he reflected on the unobtrusive fashion in which murder could stalk about. Here was the work of murder, no doubt, and it was being quietly carried along a principal London thoroughfare, without fuss or noise, by officials to whom the dealing with it was all a matter of routine. Surelyโ โMy opinion,โ said a voice at Spargoโs elbow, โmy opinion is that it was done elsewhere. Not there! He was put there. Thatโs what I say.โ Spargo turned and saw that the porter was at his side. He, too, was accompanying the body. โOh!โ said Spargo. โYou thinkโโ โI think he was struck down elsewhere and carried there,โ said the porter. โIn somebodyโs chambers, maybe. Iโve known of some queer games in our bit of London! Well!โhe never came in at my lodge last nightโIโll stand to that. And who is he, I should like to know? From what I see of him, not the sort to be about our place.โ โThatโs what we shall hear presently,โ said Spargo. โTheyโre going to search him.โ But Spargo was presently made aware that the searchers had found nothing. The police-surgeon said that the dead man had, without doubt, been struck down from behind by a terrible blow which had fractured the skull and caused death almost instantaneously. In Driscollโs opinion, the murder had been committed for the sake of plunder. For there was nothing whatever on the body. It was reasonable to suppose that a man who is well dressed would possess a watch and chain, and have money in his pockets, and possibly rings on his fingers. But there was nothing valuable to be found; in fact there was nothing at all to be found that could lead to identificationโno letters, no papers, nothing. It was plain that whoever had struck the dead man down had subsequently stripped him of whatever was on him. The only clue to possible identity lay in the fact that a soft cap of grey cloth appeared to have been newly purchased at a fashionable shop in the West End. Spargo went home; there seemed to be nothing to stop for. He ate his food and he went to bed, only to do poor things in the way of sleeping. He was not the sort to be impressed by horrors, but he recognized at last that the morningโs event had destroyed his chance of rest; he accordingly rose, took a cold bath, drank a cup of coffee, and went out. He was not sure of any particular idea when he strolled away from Bloomsbury, but it did not surprise him when, half an hour later he found that he had walked down to the police station near which the unknown manโs body lay in the mortuary. And there he met Driscoll, just going off duty. Driscoll grinned at sight of him. โYouโre in luck,โ he said. โโTisnโt five minutes since they found a bit of grey writing paper crumpled up in the poor manโs waistcoat pocketโit had slipped into a crack. Come in, and youโll see it.โ Spargo went into the inspectorโs office. In another minute he found himself staring at the scrap of paper. There was nothing on it but an address, scrawled in pencil:โRonald Breton, Barrister, Kingโs Bench Walk, Temple, London. Chapter 2 – His First Brief. Spargo looked up at the inspector with a quick jerk of his head. โI know this man,โ he said. The inspector showed new interest. โWhat, Mr. Breton?โ he asked. โYes. Iโm on the _Watchman_, you know, sub-editor. I took an article from him the other dayโarticle on โIdeal Sites for Campers-Out.โ He came to the office about it. So this was in the dead manโs pocket?โ โFound in a hole in his pocket, I understand: I wasnโt present myself. Itโs not much, but it may afford some clue to identity.โ Spargo picked up the scrap of grey paper and looked closely at it. It seemed to him to be the sort of paper that is found in hotels and in clubs; it had been torn roughly from the sheet. โWhat,โ he asked meditatively, โwhat will you do about getting this man identified?โ The inspector shrugged his shoulders. โOh, usual thing, I suppose. Thereโll be publicity, you know. I suppose youโll be doing a special account yourself, for your paper, eh? Then thereโll be the others. And we shall put out the usual notice. Somebody will come forward to identifyโsure to. Andโโ A man came into the officeโa stolid-faced, quiet-mannered, soberly attired person, who might have been a respectable tradesman out for a stroll, and who gave the inspector a sidelong nod as he approached his desk, at the same time extending his hand towards the scrap of paper which Spargo had just laid down. โIโll go along to Kingโs Bench Walk and see Mr. Breton,โ he observed, looking at his watch. โItโs just about tenโI daresay heโll be there now.โ โIโm going there, too,โ remarked Spargo, but as if speaking to himself. โYes, Iโll go there.โ The newcomer glanced at Spargo, and then at the inspector. The inspector nodded at Spargo. โJournalist,โ he said, โMr. Spargo of the _Watchman_. Mr. Spargo was there when the body was found. And he knows Mr. Breton.โ Then he nodded from Spargo to the stolid-faced person. โThis is Detective-Sergeant Rathbury, from the Yard,โ he said to Spargo. โHeโs come to take charge of this case.โ โOh?โ said Spargo blankly. โI seeโwhat,โ he went on, with sudden abruptness, โwhat shall you do about Breton?โ โGet him to come and look at the body,โ replied Rathbury. โHe may know the man and he maynโt. Anyway, his name and address are here, arenโt they?โ โCome along,โ said Spargo. โIโll walk there with you.โ Spargo remained in a species of brown study all the way along Tudor Street; his companion also maintained silence in a fashion which showed that he was by nature and custom a man of few words. It was not until the two were climbing the old balustrated staircase of the house in Kingโs Bench Walk in which Ronald Bretonโs chambers were somewhere situate that Spargo spoke. โDo you think that old chap was killed for what he may have had on him?โ he asked, suddenly turning on the detective. โI should like to know what he had on him before I answered that question, Mr. Spargo,โ replied Rathbury, with a smile. โYes,โ said Spargo, dreamily. โI suppose so. He might have hadโnothing on him, eh?โ The detective laughed, and pointed to a board on which names were printed. โWe donโt know anything yet, sir,โ he observed, โexcept that Mr. Breton is on the fourth floor. By which I conclude that it isnโt long since he was eating his dinner.โ โOh, heโs youngโheโs quite young,โ said Spargo. โI should say heโs about four-and-twenty. Iโve met him onlyโโ At that moment the unmistakable sounds of girlish laughter came down the staircase. Two girls seemed to be laughingโpresently masculine laughter mingled with the lighter feminine. โSeems to be studying law in very pleasant fashion up here, anyway,โ said Rathbury. โMr. Bretonโs chambers, too. And the doorโs open.โ The outer oak door of Ronald Bretonโs chambers stood thrown wide; the inner one was well ajar; through the opening thus made Spargo and the detective obtained a full view of the interior of Mr. Ronald Bretonโs rooms. There, against a background of law books, bundles of papers tied up with pink tape, and black-framed pictures of famous legal notabilities, they saw a pretty, vivacious-eyed girl, who, perched on a chair, wigged and gowned, and flourishing a mass of crisp paper, was haranguing an imaginary judge and jury, to the amusement of a young man who had his back to the door, and of another girl who leant confidentially against his shoulder. โI put it to you, gentlemen of the juryโI put it to you with confidence, feeling that you must be, must necessarily be, some, perhaps brothers, perhaps husbands, and fathers, can you, on your consciences do my client the great wrong, the irreparable injury, theโtheโโ โThink of some more adjectives!โ exclaimed the young man. โHot and strong โunsโpile ’em up. Thatโs what they likeโtheyโHullo!โ This exclamation arose from the fact that at this point of the proceedings the detective rapped at the inner door, and then put his head round its edge. Whereupon the young lady who was orating from the chair, jumped hastily down; the other young lady withdrew from the young manโs protecting arm; there was a feminine giggle and a feminine swishing of skirts, and a hasty bolt into an inner room, and Mr. Ronald Breton came forward, blushing a little, to greet the interrupter. โCome in, come in!โ he exclaimed hastily. โIโโ Then he paused, catching sight of Spargo, and held out his hand with a look of surprise. โOhโMr. Spargo?โ he said. โHow do you do?โweโIโwe were just having a larkโIโm off to court in a few minutes. What can I do for you, Mr. Spargo?โ He had backed to the inner door as he spoke, and he now closed it and turned again to the two men, looking from one to the other. The detective, on his part, was looking at the young barrister. He saw a tall, slimly-built youth, of handsome features and engaging presence, perfectly groomed, and immaculately garbed, and having upon him a general air of well-to-do-ness, and he formed the impression from these matters that Mr. Breton was one of those fortunate young men who may take up a profession but are certainly not dependent upon it. He turned and glanced at the journalist. โHow do you do?โ said Spargo slowly. โIโthe fact is, I came here with Mr. Rathbury. Heโwants to see you. Detective-Sergeant Rathburyโof New Scotland Yard.โ Spargo pronounced this formal introduction as if he were repeating a lesson. But he was watching the young barristerโs face. And Breton turned to the detective with a look of surprise. โOh!โ he said. โYou wishโโ Rathbury had been fumbling in his pocket for the scrap of grey paper, which he had carefully bestowed in a much-worn memorandum-book. โI wished to ask a question, Mr. Breton,โ he said. โThis morning, about a quarter to three, a manโelderly manโwas found dead in Middle Temple Lane, and there seems little doubt that he was murdered. Mr. Spargo hereโhe was present when the body was found.โ โSoon after,โ corrected Spargo. โA few minutes after.โ โWhen this body was examined at the mortuary,โ continued Rathbury, in his matter-of-fact, business-like tones, โnothing was found that could lead to identification. The man appears to have been robbed. There was nothing whatever on himโbut this bit of torn paper, which was found in a hole in the lining of his waistcoat pocket. Itโs got your name and address on it, Mr. Breton. See?โ Ronald Breton took the scrap of paper and looked at it with knitted brows. โBy Jove!โ he muttered. โSo it has; thatโs queer. Whatโs he like, this man?โ Rathbury glanced at a clock which stood on the mantelpiece. โWill you step round and take a look at him, Mr. Breton?โ he said. โItโs close by.โ โWellโIโthe fact is, Iโve got a case on, in Mr. Justice Borrowโs court,โ Breton answered, also glancing at his clock. โBut it wonโt be called until after eleven. Willโโ โPlenty of time, sir,โ said Rathbury; โit wonโt take you ten minutes to go round and back againโa look will do. You donโt recognize this handwriting, I suppose?โ Breton still held the scrap of paper in his fingers. He looked at it again, intently. โNo!โ he answered. โI donโt. I donโt know it at allโI canโt think, of course, who this man could be, to have my name and address. I thought he might have been some country solicitor, wanting my professional services, you know,โ he went on, with a shy smile at Spargo; โbut, threeโthree oโclock in the morning, eh?โ โThe doctor,โ observed Rathbury, โthe doctor thinks he had been dead about two and a half hours.โ Breton turned to the inner door. โIโllโIโll just tell these ladies Iโm going out for a quarter of an hour,โ he said. โTheyโre going over to the court with meโI got my first brief yesterday,โ he went on with a boyish laugh, glancing right and left at his visitors. โItโs nothing muchโsmall caseโbut I promised my fiancรฉe and her sister that they should be present, you know. A moment.โ He disappeared into the next room and came back a moment later in all the glory of a new silk hat. Spargo, a young man who was never very particular about his dress, began to contrast his own attire with the butterfly appearance of this youngster; he had been quick to notice that the two girls who had whisked into the inner room had been similarly garbed in fine raiment, more characteristic of Mayfair than of Fleet Street. Already he felt a strange curiosity about Breton, and about the young ladies whom he heard talking behind the inner door. โWell, come on,โ said Breton. โLetโs go straight there.โ The mortuary to which Rathbury led the way was cold, drab, repellent to the general gay sense of the summer morning. Spargo shivered involuntarily as he entered it and took a first glance around. But the young barrister showed no sign of feeling or concern; he looked quickly about him and stepped alertly to the side of the dead man, from whose face the detective was turning back a cloth. He looked steadily and earnestly at the fixed features. Then he drew back, shaking his head. โNo!โ he said with decision. โDonโt know himโdonโt know him from Adam. Never set eyes on him in my life, that I know of.โ Rathbury replaced the cloth. โI didnโt suppose you would,โ he remarked. โWell, I expect we must go on the usual lines. Somebodyโll identify him.โ โYou say he was murdered?โ said Breton. โIs thatโcertain?โ Rathbury jerked his thumb at the corpse. โThe back of his skull is smashed in,โ he said laconically. โThe doctor says he must have been struck down from behindโand a fearful blow, too. Iโm much obliged to you, Mr. Breton.โ โOh, all right!โ said Breton. โWell, you know where to find me if you want me. I shall be curious about this. Good-byeโgood-bye, Mr. Spargo.โ The young barrister hurried away, and Rathbury turned to the journalist. โI didnโt expect anything from that,โ he remarked. โHowever, it was a thing to be done. You are going to write about this for your paper?โ Spargo nodded. โWell,โ continued Rathbury, โIโve sent a man to Fiskieโs, the hatterโs, where that cap came from, you know. We may get a bit of information from that quarterโitโs possible. If you like to meet me here at twelve oโclock Iโll tell you anything Iโve heard. Just now Iโm going to get some breakfast.โ โIโll meet you here,โ said Spargo, โat twelve oโclock.โ He watched Rathbury go away round one corner; he himself suddenly set off round another. He went to the _Watchman_ office, wrote a few lines, which he enclosed in an envelope for the day-editor, and went out again. Somehow or other, his feet led him up Fleet Street, and before he quite realized what he was doing he found himself turning into the Law Courts. Chapter 3 – The Clue of the Cap. Having no clear conception of what had led him to these scenes of litigation, Spargo went wandering aimlessly about in the great hall and the adjacent corridors until an official, who took him to be lost, asked him if there was any particular part of the building he wanted. For a moment Spargo stared at the man as if he did not comprehend his question. Then his mental powers reasserted themselves. โIsnโt Mr. Justice Borrow sitting in one of the courts this morning?โ he suddenly asked. โNumber seven,โ replied the official. โWhatโs your caseโwhenโs it down?โ โI havenโt got a case,โ said Spargo. โIโm a pressmanโreporter, you know.โ The official stuck out a finger. โRound the cornerโfirst to your rightโsecond on the left,โ he said automatically. โYouโll find plenty of roomโnothing much doing there this morning.โ He turned away, and Spargo recommenced his apparently aimless perambulation of the dreary, depressing corridors. โUpon my honour!โ he muttered. โUpon my honour, I really donโt know what Iโve come up here for. Iโve no business here.โ Just then he turned a corner and came face to face with Ronald Breton. The young barrister was now in his wig and gown and carried a bundle of papers tied up with pink tape; he was escorting two young ladies, who were laughing and chattering as they tripped along at his side. And Spargo, glancing at them meditatively, instinctively told himself which of them it was that he and Rathbury had overheard as she made her burlesque speech: it was not the elder one, who walked by Ronald Breton with something of an air of proprietorship, but the younger, the girl with the laughing eyes and the vivacious smile, and it suddenly dawned upon him that somewhere, deep within him, there had been a notion, a hope of seeing this girl againโwhy, he could not then think. Spargo, thus coming face to face with these three, mechanically lifted his hat. Breton stopped, half inquisitive. His eyes seemed to ask a question. โYes,โ said Spargo. โIโthe fact is, I remembered that you said you were coming up here, and I came after you. I wantโwhen youโve timeโto have a talk, to ask you a few questions. Aboutโthis affair of the dead man, you know.โ Breton nodded. He tapped Spargo on the arm. โLook here,โ he said. โWhen this case of mine is over, I can give you as much time as you like. Can you wait a bit? Yes? Well, I say, do me a favour. I was taking these ladies round to the galleryโround there, and up the stairsโand Iโm a bit pressed for timeโIโve a solicitor waiting for me. You take themโthereโs a good fellow; then, when the case is over, bring them down here, and you and I will talk. HereโIโll introduce you allโno ceremony. Miss AylmoreโMiss Jessie Aylmore. Mr. Spargoโof the _Watchman_. Now, Iโm off!โ Breton turned on the instant; his gown whisked round a corner, and Spargo found himself staring at two smiling girls. He saw then that both were pretty and attractive, and that one seemed to be the elder by some three or four years. โThat is very cool of Ronald,โ observed the elder young lady. โPerhaps his scheme doesnโt fit in with yours, Mr. Spargo? Pray donโtโโ โOh, itโs all right!โ said Spargo, feeling himself uncommonly stupid. โIโve nothing to do. Butโwhere did Mr. Breton say you wished to be taken?โ โInto the gallery of number seven court,โ said the younger girl promptly. โRound this cornerโI think I know the way.โ Spargo, still marvelling at the rapidity with which affairs were moving that morning, bestirred himself to act as cicerone, and presently led the two young ladies to the very front of one of those public galleries from which idlers and specially-interested spectators may see and hear the proceedings which obtain in the badly-ventilated, ill-lighted tanks wherein justice is dispensed at the Law Courts. There was no one else in that gallery; the attendant in the corridor outside seemed to be vastly amazed that any one should wish to enter it, and he presently opened the door, beckoned to Spargo, and came half-way down the stairs to meet him. โNothing much going on here this morning,โ he whispered behind a raised hand. โBut thereโs a nice breach case in number fiveโget you three good seats there if you like.โ Spargo declined this tempting offer, and went back to his charges. He had decided by that time that Miss Aylmore was about twenty-three, and her sister about eighteen; he also thought that young Breton was a lucky dog to be in possession of such a charming future wife and an equally charming sister-in-law. And he dropped into a seat at Miss Jessie Aylmoreโs side, and looked around him as if he were much awed by his surroundings. โI suppose one can talk until the judge enters?โ he whispered. โIs this really Mr. Bretonโs first case?โ โHis very firstโall on his own responsibility, any way,โ replied Spargoโs companion, smiling. โAnd heโs very nervousโand soโs my sister. Arenโt you, now, Evelyn?โ Evelyn Aylmore looked at Spargo, and smiled quietly. โI suppose oneโs always nervous about first appearances,โ she said. โHowever, I think Ronaldโs got plenty of confidence, and, as he says, itโs not much of a case: it isnโt even a jury case. Iโm afraid youโll find it dull, Mr. Spargoโitโs only something about a promissory note.โ โOh, Iโm all right, thank you,โ replied Spargo, unconsciously falling back on a favourite formula. โI always like to hear lawyersโthey manage to say such a lot aboutโaboutโโ โAbout nothing,โ said Jessie Aylmore. โBut thereโso do gentlemen who write for the papers, donโt they?โ Spargo was about to admit that there was a good deal to be said on that point when Miss Aylmore suddenly drew her sisterโs attention to a man who had just entered the well of the court. โLook, Jessie!โ she observed. โThereโs Mr. Elphick!โ Spargo looked down at the person indicated: an elderly, large-faced, smooth-shaven man, a little inclined to stoutness, who, wigged and gowned, was slowly making his way to a corner seat just outside that charmed inner sanctum wherein only Kingโs Counsel are permitted to sit. He dropped into this in a fashion which showed that he was one of those men who loved personal comfort; he bestowed his plump person at the most convenient angle and fitting a monocle in his right eye, glanced around him. There were a few of his professional brethren in his vicinity; there were half a dozen solicitors and their clerks in conversation with one or other of them; there were court officials. But the gentleman of the monocle swept all these with an indifferent look and cast his eyes upward until he caught sight of the two girls. Thereupon he made a most gracious bow in their direction; his broad face beamed in a genial smile, and he waved a white hand. โDo you know Mr. Elphick, Mr. Spargo?โ enquired the younger Miss Aylmore. โI rather think Iโve seen him, somewhere about the Temple,โ answered Spargo. โIn fact, Iโm sure I have.โ โHis chambers are in Paper Buildings,โ said Jessie. โSometimes he gives tea-parties in them. He is Ronaldโs guardian, and preceptor, and mentor, and all that, and I suppose heโs dropped into this court to hear how his pupil goes on.โ โHere is Ronald,โ whispered Miss Aylmore. โAnd here,โ said her sister, โis his lordship, looking very cross. Now, Mr. Spargo, youโre in for it.โ Spargo, to tell the truth, paid little attention to what went on beneath him. The case which young Breton presently opened was a commercial one, involving certain rights and properties in a promissory note; it seemed to the journalist that Breton dealt with it very well, showing himself master of the financial details, and speaking with readiness and assurance. He was much more interested in his companions, and especially in the younger one, and he was meditating on how he could improve his further acquaintance when he awoke to the fact that the defence, realizing that it stood no chance, had agreed to withdraw, and that Mr. Justice Borrow was already giving judgment in Ronald Bretonโs favour. In another minute he was walking out of the gallery in rear of the two sisters. โVery goodโvery good, indeed,โ he said, absent-mindedly. โI thought he put his facts very clearly and concisely.โ Downstairs, in the corridor, Ronald Breton was talking to Mr. Elphick. He pointed a finger at Spargo as the latter came up with the girls: Spargo gathered that Breton was speaking of the murder and of his, Spargoโs, connection with it. And directly they approached, he spoke. โThis is Mr. Spargo, sub-editor of the _Watchman_.โ Breton said. โMr. ElphickโMr. Spargo. I was just telling Mr. Elphick, Spargo, that you saw this poor man soon after he was found.โ Spargo, glancing at Mr. Elphick, saw that he was deeply interested. The elderly barrister took himโliterallyโby the button-hole. โMy dear sir!โ he said. โYouโsaw this poor fellow? Lying deadโin the third entry down Middle Temple Lane? The third entry, eh?โ โYes,โ replied Spargo, simply. โI saw him. It was the third entry.โ โSingular!โ said Mr. Elphick, musingly. โI know a man who lives in that house. In fact, I visited him last night, and did not leave until nearly midnight. And this unfortunate man had Mr. Ronald Bretonโs name and address in his pocket?โ Spargo nodded. He looked at Breton, and pulled out his watch. Just then he had no idea of playing the part of informant to Mr. Elphick. โYes, thatโs so,โ he answered shortly. Then, looking at Breton significantly, he added, โIf you can give me those few minutes, nowโ?โ โYesโyes!โ responded Ronald Breton, nodding. โI understand. EvelynโIโll leave you and Jessie to Mr. Elphick; I must go.โ Mr. Elphick seized Spargo once more. โMy dear sir!โ he said, eagerly. โDo youโdo you think I could possibly seeโthe body?โ โItโs at the mortuary,โ answered Spargo. โI donโt know what their regulations are.โ Then he escaped with Breton. They had crossed Fleet Street and were in the quieter shades of the Temple before Spargo spoke. โAbout what I wanted to say to you,โ he said at last. โIt wasโthis. Iโwell, Iโve always wanted, as a journalist, to have a real big murder case. I think this is one. I want to go right into itโthoroughly, first and last. AndโI think you can help me.โ โHow do you know that it is a murder case?โ asked Breton quietly. โItโs a murder case,โ answered Spargo, stolidly. โI feel it. Instinct, perhaps. Iโm going to ferret out the truth. And it seems to meโโ He paused and gave his companion a sharp glance. โIt seems to me,โ he presently continued, โthat the clue lies in that scrap of paper. That paper and that man are connecting links between you andโsomebody else.โ โPossibly,โ agreed Breton. โYou want to find the somebody else?โ โI want you to help me to find the somebody else,โ answered Spargo. โI believe this is a big, very big affair: I want to do it. I donโt believe in police methodsโmuch. By the by, Iโm just going to meet Rathbury. He may have heard of something. Would you like to come?โ Breton ran into his chambers in Kingโs Bench Walk, left his gown and wig, and walked round with Spargo to the police office. Rathbury came out as they were stepping in. โOh!โ he said. โAh!โIโve got what may be helpful, Mr. Spargo. I told you Iโd sent a man to Fiskieโs, the hatter! Well, heโs just returned. The cap which the dead man was wearing was bought at Fiskieโs yesterday afternoon, and it was sent to Mr. Marbury, Room 20, at the Anglo-Orient Hotel.โ โWhere is that?โ asked Spargo. โWaterloo district,โ answered Rathbury. โA small house, I believe. Well, Iโm going there. Are you coming?โ โYes,โ replied Spargo. โOf course. And Mr. Breton wants to come, too.โ โIf Iโm not in the way,โ said Breton. Rathbury laughed. โWell, we may find out something about this scrap of paper,โ he observed. And he waved a signal to the nearest taxi-cab driver. Chapter 4 – The Anglo-Orient Hotel. The house at which Spargo and his companions presently drew up was an old-fashioned place in the immediate vicinity of Waterloo Railway Stationโa plain-fronted, four-square erection, essentially mid-Victorian in appearance, and suggestive, somehow, of the very early days of railway travelling. Anything more in contrast with the modern ideas of a hotel it would have been difficult to find in London, and Ronald Breton said so as he and the others crossed the pavement. โAnd yet a good many people used to favour this place on their way to and from Southampton in the old days,โ remarked Rathbury. โAnd I daresay that old travellers, coming back from the East after a good many yearsโ absence, still rush in here. You see, itโs close to the station, and travellers have a knack of walking into the nearest place when theyโve a few thousand miles of steamboat and railway train behind them. Look there, now!โ They had crossed the threshold as the detective spoke, and as they entered a square, heavily-furnished hall, he made a sidelong motion of his head towards a bar on the left, wherein stood or lounged a number of men who from their general appearance, their slouched hats, and their bronzed faces appeared to be Colonials, or at any rate to have spent a good part of their time beneath Oriental skies. There was a murmur of tongues that had a Colonial accent in it; an aroma of tobacco that suggested Sumatra and Trichinopoly, and Rathbury wagged his head sagely. โLay you anything the dead man was a Colonial, Mr. Spargo,โ he remarked. โWell, now, I suppose thatโs the landlord and landlady.โ There was an office facing them, at the rear of the hall, and a man and woman were regarding them from a box window which opened above a ledge on which lay a register book. They were middle-aged folk: the man, a fleshy, round-faced, somewhat pompous-looking individual, who might at some time have been a butler; the woman a tall, spare-figured, thin-featured, sharp-eyed person, who examined the newcomers with an enquiring gaze. Rathbury went up to them with easy confidence. โYou the landlord of this house, sir?โ he asked. โMr. Walters? Just soโand Mrs. Walters, I presume?โ The landlord made a stiff bow and looked sharply at his questioner. โWhat can I do for you, sir?โ he enquired. โA little matter of business, Mr. Walters,โ replied Rathbury, pulling out a card. โYouโll see there who I amโDetective-Sergeant Rathbury, of the Yard. This is Mr. Frank Spargo, a newspaper man; this is Mr. Ronald Breton, a barrister.โ The landlady, hearing their names and description, pointed to a side door, and signed Rathbury and his companions to pass through. Obeying her pointed finger, they found themselves in a small private parlour. Walters closed the two doors which led into it and looked at his principal visitor. โWhat is it, Mr. Rathbury?โ he enquired. โAnything wrong?โ โWe want a bit of information,โ answered Rathbury, almost with indifference. โDid anybody of the name of Marbury put up here yesterdayโelderly man, grey hair, fresh complexion?โ Mrs. Walters started, glancing at her husband. โThere!โ she exclaimed. โI knew some enquiry would be made. Yesโa Mr. Marbury took a room here yesterday morning, just after the noon train got in from Southampton. Number 20 he took. Butโhe didnโt use it last night. He went outโvery lateโand he never came back.โ Rathbury nodded. Answering a sign from the landlord, he took a chair and, sitting down, looked at Mrs. Walters. โWhat made you think some enquiry would be made, maโam?โ he asked. โHad you noticed anything?โ Mrs. Walters seemed a little confused by this direct question. Her husband gave vent to a species of growl. โNothing to notice,โ he muttered. โHer way of speakingโthatโs all.โ โWellโwhy I said that was this,โ said the landlady. โHe happened to tell us, did Mr. Marbury, that he hadnโt been in London for over twenty years, and couldnโt remember anything about it, him, he said, never having known much about London at any time. And, of course, when he went out so late and never came back, why, naturally, I thought something had happened to him, and that thereโd be enquiries made.โ โJust soโjust so!โ said Rathbury. โSo you would, maโamโso you would. Well, something has happened to him. Heโs dead. Whatโs more, thereโs strong reason to think he was murdered.โ Mr. and Mrs. Walters received this announcement with proper surprise and horror, and the landlord suggested a little refreshment to his visitors. Spargo and Breton declined, on the ground that they had work to do during the afternoon; Rathbury accepted it, evidently as a matter of course. โMy respects,โ he said, lifting his glass. โWell, now, perhaps youโll just tell me what you know of this man? I may as well tell you, Mr. and Mrs. Walters, that he was found dead in Middle Temple Lane this morning, at a quarter to three; that there wasnโt anything on him but his clothes and a scrap of paper which bore this gentlemanโs name and address; that this gentleman knows nothing whatever of him, and that I traced him here because he bought a cap at a West End hatterโs yesterday, and had it sent to your hotel.โ โYes,โ said Mrs. Walters quickly, โthatโs so. And he went out in that cap last night. Wellโwe donโt know much about him. As I said, he came in here about a quarter past twelve yesterday morning, and booked Number 20. He had a porter with him that brought a trunk and a bagโtheyโre in 20 now, of course. He told me that he had stayed at this house over twenty years ago, on his way to Australiaโthat, of course, was long before we took it. And he signed his name in the book as John Marbury.โ โWeโll look at that, if you please,โ said Rathbury. Walters fetched in the register and turned the leaf to the previous dayโs entries. They all bent over the dead manโs writing. โโJohn Marbury, Coolumbidgee, New South Wales,โโ said Rathbury. โAhโnow I was wondering if that writing would be the same as that on the scrap of paper, Mr. Breton. But, you see, it isnโtโitโs quite different.โ โQuite different,โ said Breton. He, too, was regarding the handwriting with great interest. And Rathbury noticed his keen inspection of it, and asked another question. โEver seen that writing before?โ he suggested. โNever,โ answered Breton. โAnd yetโthereโs something very familiar about it.โ โThen the probability is that you have seen it before,โ remarked Rathbury. โWellโnow weโll hear a little more about Marburyโs doings here. Just tell me all you know, Mr. and Mrs. Walters.โ โMy wife knows most,โ said Walters. โI scarcely saw the manโI donโt remember speaking with him.โ โNo,โ said Mrs. Walters. โYou didnโtโyou werenโt much in his way. Well,โ she continued, โI showed him up to his room. He talked a bitโsaid heโd just landed at Southampton from Melbourne.โ โDid he mention his ship?โ asked Rathbury. โBut if he didnโt, it doesnโt matter, for we can find out.โ โI believe the nameโs on his things,โ answered the landlady. โThere are some labels of that sort. Well, he asked for a chop to be cooked for him at once, as he was going out. He had his chop, and he went out at exactly one oโclock, saying to me that he expected heโd get lost, as he didnโt know London well at any time, and shouldnโt know it at all now. He went outside thereโI saw himโlooked about him and walked off towards Blackfriars way. During the afternoon the cap you spoke of came for himโfrom Fiskieโs. So, of course, I judged heโd been Piccadilly way. But he himself never came in until ten oโclock. And then he brought a gentleman with him.โ โAye?โ said Rathbury. โA gentleman, now? Did you see him?โ โJust,โ replied the landlady. โThey went straight up to 20, and I just caught a mere glimpse of the gentleman as they turned up the stairs. A tall, well-built gentleman, with a grey beard, very well dressed as far as I could see, with a top hat and a white silk muffler round his throat, and carrying an umbrella.โ โAnd they went to Marburyโs room?โ said Rathbury. โWhat then?โ โWell, then, Mr. Marbury rang for some whiskey and soda,โ continued Mrs. Walters. โHe was particular to have a decanter of whiskey: that, and a syphon of soda were taken up there. I heard nothing more until nearly midnight; then the hall-porter told me that the gentleman in 20 had gone out, and had asked him if there was a night-porterโas, of course, there is. He went out at half-past eleven.โ โAnd the other gentleman?โ asked Rathbury. โThe other gentleman,โ answered the landlady, โwent out with him. The hall-porter said they turned towards the station. And that was the last anybody in this house saw of Mr. Marbury. He certainly never came back.โ โThat,โ observed Rathbury with a quiet smile, โthat is quite certain, maโam? WellโI suppose weโd better see this Number 20 room, and have a look at what he left there.โ โEverything,โ said Mrs. Walters, โis just as he left it. Nothingโs been touched.โ It seemed to two of the visitors that there was little to touch. On the dressing-table lay a few ordinary articles of toiletโnone of them of any quality or value: the dead man had evidently been satisfied with the plain necessities of life. An overcoat hung from a peg: Rathbury, without ceremony, went through its pockets; just as unceremoniously he proceeded to examine trunk and bag, and finding both unlocked, he laid out on the bed every article they contained and examined each separately and carefully. And he found nothing whereby he could gather any clue to the dead ownerโs identity. โThere you are!โ he said, making an end of his task. โYou see, itโs just the same with these things as with the clothes he had on him. There are no papersโthereโs nothing to tell who he was, what he was after, where heโd come fromโthough that we may find out in other ways. But itโs not often that a man travels without some clue to his identity. Beyond the fact that some of this linen was, you see, bought in Melbourne, we know nothing of him. Yet he must have had papers and money on him. Did you see anything of his money, now, maโam?โ he asked, suddenly turning to Mrs. Walters. โDid he pull out his purse in your presence, now?โ โYes,โ answered the landlady, with promptitude. โHe came into the bar for a drink after heโd been up to his room. He pulled out a handful of gold when he paid for itโa whole handful. There must have been some thirty to forty sovereigns and half-sovereigns.โ โAnd he hadnโt a penny piece on himโwhen found,โ muttered Rathbury. โI noticed another thing, too,โ remarked the landlady. โHe was wearing a very fine gold watch and chain, and had a splendid ring on his left handโlittle fingerโgold, with a big diamond in it.โ โYes,โ said the detective, thoughtfully, โI noticed that heโd worn a ring, and that it had been a bit tight for him. Wellโnow thereโs only one thing to ask about. Did your chambermaid notice if he left any torn paper aroundโtore any letters up, or anything like that?โ But the chambermaid, produced, had not noticed anything of the sort; on the contrary, the gentleman of Number 20 had left his room very tidy indeed. So Rathbury intimated that he had no more to ask, and nothing further to say, just then, and he bade the landlord and landlady of the Anglo-Orient Hotel good morning, and went away, followed by the two young men. โWhat next?โ asked Spargo, as they gained the street. โThe next thing,โ answered Rathbury, โis to find the man with whom Marbury left this hotel last night.โ โAnd howโs that to be done?โ asked Spargo. โAt present,โ replied Rathbury, โI donโt know.โ And with a careless nod, he walked off, apparently desirous of being alone. Chapter 5 – Spargo Wishes to Specialize. The barrister and the journalist, left thus unceremoniously on a crowded pavement, looked at each other. Breton laughed. โWe donโt seem to have gained much information,โ he remarked. โIโm about as wise as ever.โ โNoโwiser,โ said Spargo. โAt any rate, I am. I know now that this dead man called himself John Marbury; that he came from Australia; that he only landed at Southampton yesterday morning, and that he was in the company last night of a man whom we have had described to usโa tall, grey-bearded, well-dressed man, presumably a gentleman.โ Breton shrugged his shoulders. โI should say that description would fit a hundred thousand men in London,โ he remarked. โExactlyโso it would,โ answered Spargo. โBut we know that it was one of the hundred thousand, or half-million, if you like. The thing is to find that oneโthe one.โ โAnd you think you can do it?โ โI think Iโm going to have a big try at it.โ Breton shrugged his shoulders again. โWhat?โby going up to every man who answers the description, and saying โSir, are you the man who accompanied John Marbury to the Angloโโโ Spargo suddenly interrupted him. โLook here!โ he said. โDidnโt you say that you knew a man who lives in that block in the entry of which Marbury was found?โ โNo, I didnโt,โ answered Breton. โIt was Mr. Elphick who said that. All the same, I do know that manโheโs Mr. Cardlestone, another barrister. He and Mr. Elphick are friendsโtheyโre both enthusiastic philatelistsโstamp collectors, you knowโand I dare say Mr. Elphick was round there last night examining something new Cardlestoneโs got hold of. Why?โ โIโd like to go round there and make some enquiries,โ replied Spargo. โIf youโd be kind enough toโโโ โOh, Iโll go with you!โ responded Breton, with alacrity. โIโm just as keen about this business as you are, Spargo! I want to know who this man Marbury is, and how he came to have my name and address on him. Now, if I had been a well-known man in my profession, you know, whyโโ โYes,โ said Spargo, as they got into a cab, โyes, that would have explained a lot. It seems to me that weโll get at the murderer through that scrap of paper a lot quicker than through Rathburyโs line. Yes, thatโs what I think.โ Breton looked at his companion with interest. โButโyou donโt know what Rathburyโs line is,โ he remarked. โYes, I do,โ said Spargo. โRathburyโs gone off to discover who the man is with whom Marbury left the Anglo-Orient Hotel last night. Thatโs his line.โ โAnd you wantโโ?โ โI want to find out the full significance of that bit of paper, and who wrote it,โ answered Spargo. โI want to know why that old man was coming to you when he was murdered.โ Breton started. โBy Jove!โ he exclaimed. โIโI never thought of that. Youโyou really think he was coming to me when he was struck down?โ โCertain. Hadnโt he got an address in the Temple? Wasnโt he in the Temple? Of course, he was trying to find you.โ โButโthe late hour?โ โNo matter. How else can you explain his presence in the Temple? I think he was asking his way. Thatโs why I want to make some enquiries in this block.โ It appeared to Spargo that a considerable number of people, chiefly of the office-boy variety, were desirous of making enquiries about the dead man. Being luncheon-hour, that bit of Middle Temple Lane where the body was found, was thick with the inquisitive and the sensation-seeker, for the news of the murder had spread, and though there was nothing to see but the bare stones on which the body had lain, there were more open mouths and staring eyes around the entry than Spargo had seen for many a day. And the nuisance had become so great that the occupants of the adjacent chambers had sent for a policeman to move the curious away, and when Spargo and his companion presented themselves at the entry this policeman was being lectured as to his duties by a little weazen-faced gentleman, in very snuffy and old-fashioned garments, and an ancient silk hat, who was obviously greatly exercised by the unwonted commotion. โDrive them all out into the street!โ exclaimed this personage. โDrive them all away, constableโinto Fleet Street or upon the Embankmentโanywhere, so long as you rid this place of them. This is a disgrace, and an inconvenience, a nuisance, aโโโ โThatโs old Cardlestone,โ whispered Breton. โHeโs always irascible, and I donโt suppose weโll get anything out of him. Mr. Cardlestone,โ he continued, making his way up to the old gentleman who was now retreating up the stone steps, brandishing an umbrella as ancient as himself. โI was just coming to see you, sir. This is Mr. Spargo, a journalist, who is much interested in this murder. Heโโโ โI know nothing about the murder, my dear sir!โ exclaimed Mr. Cardlestone. โAnd I never talk to journalistsโa pack of busybodies, sir, saving your presence. I am not aware that any murder has been committed, and I object to my doorway being filled by a pack of office boys and street loungers. Murder indeed! I suppose the man fell down these steps and broke his neckโdrunk, most likely.โ He opened his outer door as he spoke, and Breton, with a reassuring smile and a nod at Spargo, followed him into his chambers on the first landing, motioning the journalist to keep at their heels. โMr. Elphick tells me that he was with you until a late hour last evening, Mr. Cardlestone,โ he said. โOf course, neither of you heard anything suspicious?โ โWhat should we hear that was suspicious in the Temple, sir?โ demanded Mr. Cardlestone, angrily. โI hope the Temple is free from that sort of thing, young Mr. Breton. Your respected guardian and myself had a quiet evening on our usual peaceful pursuits, and when he went away all was as quiet as the grave, sir. What may have gone on in the chambers above and around me I know not! Fortunately, our walls are thick, sirโsubstantial. I say, sir, the man probably fell down and broke his neck. What he was doing here, I do not presume to say.โ โWell, itโs guess, you know, Mr. Cardlestone,โ remarked Breton, again winking at Spargo. โBut all that was found on this man was a scrap of paper on which my name and address were written. Thatโs practically all that was known of him, except that heโd just arrived from Australia.โ Mr. Cardlestone suddenly turned on the young barrister with a sharp, acute glance. โEh?โ he exclaimed. โWhatโs this? You say this man had your name and address on him, young Breton!โyours? And that he came fromโAustralia?โ โThatโs so,โ answered Breton. โThatโs all thatโs known.โ Mr. Cardlestone put aside his umbrella, produced a bandanna handkerchief of strong colours, and blew his nose in a reflective fashion. โThatโs a mysterious thing,โ he observed. โUmโdoes Elphick know all that?โ Breton looked at Spargo as if he was asking him for an explanation of Mr. Cardlestoneโs altered manner. And Spargo took up the conversation. โNo,โ he said. โAll that Mr. Elphick knows is that Mr. Ronald Bretonโs name and address were on the scrap of paper found on the body. Mr. Elphickโโhere Spargo paused and looked at BretonโโMr. Elphick,โ he presently continued, slowly transferring his glance to the old barrister, โspoke of going to view the body.โ โAh!โ exclaimed Mr. Cardlestone, eagerly. โIt can be seen? Then Iโll go and see it. Where is it?โ Breton started. โButโmy dear sir!โ he said. โWhy?โ Mr. Cardlestone picked up his umbrella again. โI feel a proper curiosity about a mystery which occurs at my very door,โ he said. โAlso, I have known more than one man who went to Australia. This mightโI say might, young gentlemenโmight be a man I had once known. Show me where this body is.โ Breton looked helplessly at Spargo: it was plain that he did not understand the turn that things were taking. But Spargo was quick to seize an opportunity. In another minute he was conducting Mr. Cardlestone through the ins and outs of the Temple towards Blackfriars. And as they turned into Tudor Street they encountered Mr. Elphick. โI am going to the mortuary,โ he remarked. โSo, I suppose, are you, Cardlestone? Has anything more been discovered, young man?โ Spargo tried a chance shotโat what he did not know. โThe manโs name was Marbury,โ he said. โHe was from Australia.โ He was keeping a keen eye on Mr. Elphick, but he failed to see that Mr. Elphick showed any of the surprise which Mr. Cardlestone had exhibited. Rather, he seemed indifferent. โOh?โ he saidโโMarbury? And from Australia. WellโI should like to see the body.โ Spargo and Breton had to wait outside the mortuary while the two elder gentlemen went in. There was nothing to be learnt from either when they reappeared. โWe donโt know the man,โ said Mr. Elphick, calmly. โAs Mr. Cardlestone, I understand, has said to you alreadyโwe have known men who went to Australia, and as this man was evidently wandering about the Temple, we thought it might have been one of them, come back. Butโwe donโt recognize him.โ โCouldnโt recognize him,โ said Mr. Cardlestone. โNo!โ They went away together arm in arm, and Breton looked at Spargo. โAs if anybody on earth ever fancied theyโd recognize him!โ he said. โWellโwhat are you going to do now, Spargo? I must go.โ Spargo, who had been digging his walking-stick into a crack in the pavement, came out of a fit of abstraction. โI?โ he said. โOhโIโm going to the office. โ And he turned abruptly away, and walking straight off to the editorial rooms at the _Watchman_, made for one in which sat the official guardian of the editor. โTry to get me a few minutes with the chief,โ he said. The private secretary looked up. โReally important?โ he asked. โBig!โ answered Spargo. โFix it.โ Once closeted with the great man, whose idiosyncrasies he knew pretty well by that time, Spargo lost no time. โYouโve heard about this murder in Middle Temple Lane?โ he suggested. โThe mere facts,โ replied the editor, tersely. โI was there when the body was found,โ continued Spargo, and gave a brief rรฉsumรฉ of his doings. โIโm certain this is a most unusual affair,โ he went on. โItโs as full of mystery asโas it could be. I want to give my attention to it. I want to specialize on it. I can make such a story of it as we havenโt had for some timeโages. Let me have it. And to start with, let me have two columns for tomorrow morning. Iโll make itโbig!โ The editor looked across his desk at Spargoโs eager face. โYour other work?โ he said. โWell in hand,โ replied Spargo. โIโm ahead a whole weekโboth articles and reviews. I can tackle both.โ The editor put his finger tips together. โHave you got some idea about this, young man?โ he asked. โIโve got a great idea,โ answered Spargo. He faced the great man squarely, and stared at him until he had brought a smile to the editorial face. โThatโs why I want to do it,โ he added. โAndโitโs not mere boasting nor over-confidenceโI know I shall do it better than anybody else.โ The editor considered matters for a brief moment. โYou mean to find out who killed this man?โ he said at last. Spargo nodded his headโtwice. โIโll find that out,โ he said doggedly. The editor picked up a pencil, and bent to his desk. โAll right,โ he said. โGo ahead. You shall have your two columns.โ Spargo went quietly away to his own nook and corner. He got hold of a block of paper and began to write. He was going to show how to do things. Chapter 6 – Witness to a Meeting. Ronald Breton walked into the _Watchman_ office and into Spargoโs room next morning holding a copy of the current issue in his hand. He waved it at Spargo with an enthusiasm which was almost boyish. โI say!โ he exclaimed. โThatโs the way to do it, Spargo! I congratulate you. Yes, thatโs the wayโcertain!โ Spargo, idly turning over a pile of exchanges, yawned. โWhat way?โ he asked indifferently. โThe way youโve written this thing up,โ said Breton. โItโs a hundred thousand times better than the usual cut-and-dried account of a murder. Itโsโitโs like aโa romance!โ โMerely a new method of giving news,โ said Spargo. He picked up a copy of the _Watchman_, and glanced at his two columns, which had somehow managed to make themselves into three, viewing the displayed lettering, the photograph of the dead man, the line drawing of the entry in Middle Temple Lane, and the facsimile of the scrap of grey paper, with a critical eye. โYesโmerely a new method,โ he continued. โThe question isโwill it achieve its object?โ โWhatโs the object?โ asked Breton. Spargo fished out a box of cigarettes from an untidy drawer, pushed it over to his visitor, helped himself, and tilting back his chair, put his feet on his desk. โThe object?โ he said, drily. โOh, well, the object is the ultimate detection of the murderer.โ โYouโre after that?โ โIโm after thatโjust that.โ โAnd notโnot simply out to make effective news?โ โIโm out to find the murderer of John Marbury,โ said Spargo deliberately slow in his speech. โAnd Iโll find him.โ โWell, there doesnโt seem to be much in the way of clues, so far,โ remarked Breton. โI seeโnothing. Do you?โ Spargo sent a spiral of scented smoke into the air. โI want to know an awful lot,โ he said. โIโm hungering for news. I want to know who John Marbury is. I want to know what he did with himself between the time when he walked out of the Anglo-Orient Hotel, alive and well, and the time when he was found in Middle Temple Lane, with his skull beaten in and dead. I want to know where he got that scrap of paper. Above everything, Breton, I want to know what heโd got to do with you!โ He gave the young barrister a keen look, and Breton nodded. โYes,โ he said. โI confess thatโs a corker. But I thinkโโโ โWell?โ said Spargo. โI think he may have been a man who had some legal business in hand, or in prospect, and had been recommended toโme,โ said Breton. Spargo smiledโa little sardonically. โThatโs good!โ he said. โYou had your very first briefโyesterday. Comeโyour fame isnโt blown abroad through all the heights yet, my friend! Besidesโdonโt intending clients approachโisnโt it strict etiquette for them to approach?โbarristers through solicitors?โ โQuite rightโin both your remarks,โ replied Breton, good-humouredly. โOf course, Iโm not known a bit, but all the same Iโve known several cases where a barrister has been approached in the first instance and asked to recommend a solicitor. Somebody who wanted to do me a good turn may have given this man my address.โ โPossible,โ said Spargo. โBut he wouldnโt have come to consult you at midnight. Breton!โthe more I think of it, the more Iโm certain thereโs a tremendous mystery in this affair! Thatโs why I got the chief to let me write it up as I have doneโhere. Iโm hoping that this photographโthough to be sure, itโs of a dead faceโand this facsimile of the scrap of paper will lead to somebody coming forward who canโโโ Just then one of the uniformed youths who hang about the marble pillared vestibule of the _Watchman_ office came into the room with the unmistakable look and air of one who carries news of moment. โI dare lay a sovereign to a cent that I know what this is,โ muttered Spargo in an aside. โWell?โ he said to the boy. โWhat is it?โ The messenger came up to the desk. โMr. Spargo,โ he said, โthereโs a man downstairs who says that he wants to see somebody about that murder case thatโs in the paper this morning, sir. Mr. Barrett said I was to come to you.โ โWho is the man?โ asked Spargo. โWonโt say, sir,โ replied the boy. โI gave him a form to fill up, but he said he wouldnโt write anythingโsaid all he wanted was to see the man who wrote the piece in the paper.โ โBring him here,โ commanded Spargo. He turned to Breton when the boy had gone, and he smiled. โI knew we should have somebody here sooner or later,โ he said. โThatโs why I hurried over my breakfast and came down at ten oโclock. Now then, what will you bet on the chances of this chapโs information proving valuable?โ โNothing,โ replied Breton. โHeโs probably some crank or faddist whoโs got some theory that he wants to ventilate.โ The man who was presently ushered in by the messenger seemed from preliminary and outward appearance to justify Bretonโs prognostication. He was obviously a countryman, a tall, loosely-built, middle-aged man, yellow of hair, blue of eye, who was wearing his Sunday-best array of pearl-grey trousers and black coat, and sported a necktie in which were several distinct colours. Oppressed with the splendour and grandeur of the _Watchman_ building, he had removed his hard billycock hat as he followed the boy, and he ducked his bared head at the two young men as he stepped on to the thick pile of the carpet which made luxurious footing in Spargoโs room. His blue eyes, opened to their widest, looked round him in astonishment at the sumptuousness of modern newspaper-office accommodation. โHow do you do, sir?โ said Spargo, pointing a finger to one of the easy-chairs for which the _Watchman_ office is famous. โI understand that you wish to see me?โ The caller ducked his yellow head again, sat down on the edge of the chair, put his hat on the floor, picked it up again, and endeavoured to hang it on his knee, and looked at Spargo innocently and shyly. โWhat I want to see, sir,โ he observed in a rustic accent, โis the gentleman as wrote that piece in your newspaper about this here murder in Middle Temple Lane.โ โYou see him,โ said Spargo. โI am that man.โ The caller smiledโgenerously. โIndeed, sir?โ he said. โA very nice bit of reading, Iโm sure. And what might your name be, now, sir? I can always talk free-er to a man when I know what his name is.โ โSo can I,โ answered Spargo. โMy name is SpargoโFrank Spargo. Whatโs yours?โ โName of Webster, sirโWilliam Webster. I farm at One Ash Farm, at Gosberton, in Oakshire. Me and my wife,โ continued Mr. Webster, again smiling and distributing his smile between both his hearers, โis at present in London on a holiday. And very pleasant we find itโweather and all.โ โThatโs right,โ said Spargo. โAndโyou wanted to see me about this murder, Mr. Webster?โ โI did, sir. Me, I believe, knowing, as I think, something thatโll do for you to put in your paper. You see, Mr. Spargo, it come about in this fashionโhappen youโll be for me to tell it in my own way.โ โThat,โ answered Spargo, โis precisely what I desire.โ โWell, to be sure, I couldnโt tell it in no other,โ declared Mr. Webster. โYou see, sir, I read your paper this morning while I was waiting for my breakfastโthey take their breakfasts so late in them hotelsโand when Iโd read it, and looked at the pictures, I says to my wife โAs soon as Iโve had my breakfast,โ I says, โIโm going to where they print this newspaper to tell ’em something.โ โAye?โ she says, โWhy, what have you to tell, I should like to know?โ just like that, Mr. Spargo.โ โMrs. Webster,โ said Spargo, โis a lady of businesslike principles. And what have you to tell?โ Mr. Webster looked into the crown of his hat, looked out of it, and smiled knowingly. โWell, sir,โ he continued, โLast night, my wife, she went out to a part they call Clapham, to take her tea and supper with an old friend of hers as lives there, and as they wanted to have a bit of woman-talk, like, I didnโt go. So thinks I to myself, Iโll go and see this here House of Commons. There was a neighbour of mine as had told me that all youโd got to do was to tell the policeman at the door that you wanted to see your own Member of Parliament. So when I got there I told ’em that I wanted to see our M.P., Mr. Stonewoodโyouโll have heard tell of him, no doubt; he knows me very wellโand they passed me, and I wrote out a ticket for him, and they told me to sit down while they found him. So I sat down in a grand sort of hall where there were a rare lot of people going and coming, and some fine pictures and images to look at, and for a time I looked at them, and then I began to take a bit of notice of the folk near at hand, waiting, you know, like myself. And as sure as Iโm a christened man, sir, the gentleman whose picture youโve got in your paperโhim as was murderedโwas sitting next to me! I knew that picture as soon as I saw it this morning.โ Spargo, who had been making unmeaning scribbles on a block of paper, suddenly looked at his visitor. โWhat time was that?โ he asked. โIt was between a quarter and half-past nine, sir,โ answered Mr. Webster. โIt might haโ been twenty pastโit might haโ been twenty-five past.โ โGo on, if you please,โ said Spargo. โWell, sir, me and this here dead gentleman talked a bit. About what a long time it took to get a member to attend to you, and such-like. I made mention of the fact that I hadnโt been in there before. โNeither have I!โ he says, โI came in out of curiosity,โ he says, and then he laughed, sirโqueer-like. And it was just after that that what Iโm going to tell you about happened.โ โTell,โ commanded Spargo. โWell, sir, there was a gentleman came along, down this grand hall that we were sitting inโa tall, handsome gentleman, with a grey beard. Heโd no hat on, and he was carrying a lot of paper and documents in his hand, so I thought he was happen one of the members. And all of a sudden this here man at my side, he jumps up with a sort of start and an exclamation, andโโโ Spargo lifted his hand. He looked keenly at his visitor. โNow, youโre absolutely sure about what you heard him exclaim?โ he asked. โQuite sure about it? Because I see you are going to tell us what he did exclaim.โ โIโll tell you naught but what Iโm certain of, sir,โ replied Webster. โWhat he said as he jumped up was โGood God!โ he says, sharp-likeโand then he said a name, and I didnโt right catch it, but it sounded like Danesworth, or Painesworth, or something of that sortโone of them there, or very like ’em, at any rate. And then he rushed up to this here gentleman, and laid his hand on his armโsudden-like.โ โAndโthe gentleman?โ asked Spargo, quietly. โWell, he seemed taken aback, sir. He jumped. Then he stared at the man. Then they shook hands. And then, after theyโd spoken a few words together-like, they walked off, talking. And, of course, I never saw no more of ’em. But when I saw your paper this morning, sir, and that picture in it, I said to myself โThatโs the man I sat next to in that there hall at the House of Commons!โ Oh, thereโs no doubt of it, sir!โ โAnd supposing you saw a photograph of the tall gentleman with the grey beard?โ suggested Spargo. โCould you recognize him from that?โ โMake no doubt of it, sir,โ answered Mr. Webster. โI observed him particular.โ Spargo rose, and going over to a cabinet, took from it a thick volume, the leaves of which he turned over for several minutes. โCome here, if you please, Mr. Webster,โ he said. The farmer went across the room. โThere is a full set of photographs of members of the present House of Commons here,โ said Spargo. โNow, pick out the one you saw. Take your timeโand be sure.โ He left his caller turning over the album and went back to Breton. โThere!โ he whispered. โGetting nearerโa bit nearerโeh?โ โTo what?โ asked Breton. โI donโt seeโโ A sudden exclamation from the farmer interrupted Bretonโs remark. โThis is him, sir!โ answered Mr. Webster. โThatโs the gentlemanโknow him anywhere!โ The two young men crossed the room. The farmer was pointing a stubby finger to a photograph, beneath which was written _Stephen Aylmore, Esq., M.P. for Brookminster_. Chapter 7 – Mr. Aylmore. Spargo, keenly observant and watchful, felt, rather than saw, Breton start; he himself preserved an imperturbable equanimity. He gave a mere glance at the photograph to which Mr. Webster was pointing. โOh!โ he said. โThat he?โ โThatโs the gentleman, sir,โ replied Webster. โDone to the life, that is. No difficulty in recognizing of that, Mr. Spargo.โ โYouโre absolutely sure?โ demanded Spargo. โThere are a lot of men in the House of Commons, you know, who wear beards, and many of the beards are grey.โ But Webster wagged his head. โThatโs him, sir!โ he repeated. โIโm as sure of that as I am that my nameโs William Webster. Thatโs the man I saw talking to him whose picture youโve got in your paper. Canโt say no more, sir.โ โVery good,โ said Spargo. โIโm much obliged to you. Iโll see Mr. Aylmore. Leave me your address in London, Mr. Webster. How long do you remain in town?โ โMy address is the Beachcroft Hotel, Bloomsbury, sir, and I shall be there for another week,โ answered the farmer. โHope Iโve been of some use, Mr. Spargo. As I says to my wifeโโโ Spargo cut his visitor short in polite fashion and bowed him out. He turned to Breton, who still stood staring at the album of portraits. โThere!โwhat did I tell you?โ he said. โDidnโt I say I should get some news? There it is.โ Breton nodded his head. He seemed thoughtful. โYes,โ he agreed. โYes, I say, Spargo!โ โWell?โ โMr. Aylmore is my prospective father-in-law, you know.โ โQuite aware of it. Didnโt you introduce me to his daughtersโonly yesterday?โ โButโhow did you know they were his daughters?โ Spargo laughed as he sat down to his desk. โInstinctโintuition,โ he answered. โHowever, never mind that, just now. WellโIโve found something out. Marburyโif that is the dead manโs real name, and anyway, itโs all we know him byโwas in the company of Mr. Aylmore that night. Good!โ โWhat are you going to do about it?โ asked Breton. โDo? See Mr. Aylmore, of course.โ He was turning over the leaves of a telephone address-book; one hand had already picked up the mouthpiece of the instrument on his desk. โLook here,โ said Breton. โI know where Mr. Aylmore is always to be found at twelve oโclock. At the A. and P.โthe Atlantic and Pacific Club, you know, in St. Jamesโs. If you like, Iโll go with you.โ Spargo glanced at the clock and laid down the telephone. โAll right,โ he said. โEleven oโclock, now. Iโve something to do. Iโll meet you outside the A. and P. at exactly noon.โ โIโll be there,โ agreed Breton. He made for the door, and with his hand on it, turned. โWhat do you expect fromโfrom what weโve just heard?โ he asked. Spargo shrugged his shoulders. โWaitโuntil we hear what Mr. Aylmore has to say,โ he answered. โI suppose this man Marbury was some old acquaintance.โ Breton closed the door and went away: left alone, Spargo began to mutter to himself. โGood God!โ he says. โDainsworthโPainsworthโsomething of that sortโone of the two. Excellentโthat our farmer friend should have so much observation. Ah!โand why should Mr. Stephen Aylmore be recognized as Dainsworth or Painsworth or something of that sort. Now, who is Mr. Stephen Aylmoreโbeyond being what I know him to be?โ Spargoโs fingers went instinctively to one of a number of books of reference which stood on his desk: they turned with practised swiftness to a page over which his eye ran just as swiftly. He read aloud: โAYLMORE, STEPHEN, M.P. for Brookminster since 1910. Residences: 23, St. Osythe Court, Kensington: Buena Vista, Great Marlow. Member Atlantic and Pacific and City Venturersโ Clubs. Interested in South American enterprise.โ โUm!โ muttered Spargo, putting the book away. โThatโs not very illuminating. However, weโve got one move finished. Now weโll make another.โ Going over to the album of photographs, Spargo deftly removed that of Mr. Aylmore, put it in an envelope and the envelope in his pocket and, leaving the office, hailed a taxi-cab, and ordered its driver to take him to the Anglo-Orient Hotel. This was the something-to-do of which he had spoken to Breton: Spargo wanted to do it alone. Mrs. Walters was in her low-windowed office when Spargo entered the hall; she recognized him at once and motioned him into her parlour. โI remember you,โ said Mrs. Walters; โyou came with the detectiveโMr. Rathbury.โ โHave you seen him, since?โ asked Spargo. โNot since,โ replied Mrs. Walters. โNoโand I was wondering if heโd be coming round, becauseโโโ She paused there and looked at Spargo with particular enquiryโโYouโre a friend of his, arenโt you?โ she asked. โI suppose you know as much as he doesโabout this?โ โHe and I,โ replied Spargo, with easy confidence, โare working this case together. You can tell me anything youโd tell him.โ The landlady rummaged in her pocket and produced an old purse, from an inner compartment of which she brought out a small object wrapped in tissue paper. โWell,โ she said, unwrapping the paper, โwe found this in Number 20 this morningโit was lying under the dressing-table. The girl that found it brought it to me, and I thought it was a bit of glass, but Walters, he says as how he shouldnโt be surprised if itโs a diamond. And since we found it, the waiter who took the whisky up to 20, after Mr. Marbury came in with the other gentleman, has told me that when he went into the room the two gentlemen were looking at a paper full of things like this. So there?โ Spargo fingered the shining bit of stone. โThatโs a diamondโright enough,โ he said. โPut it away, Mrs. WaltersโI shall see Rathbury presently, and Iโll tell him about it. Now, that other gentleman! You told us you saw him. Could you recognize himโI mean, a photograph of him? Is this the man?โ Spargo knew from the expression of Mrs. Waltersโ face that she had no more doubt than Webster had. โOh, yes!โ she said. โThatโs the gentleman who came in with Mr. MarburyโI should have known him in a thousand. Anybody would recognize him from thatโperhaps youโd let our hall-porter and the waiter I mentioned just now look at it?โ โIโll see them separately and see if theyโve ever seen a man who resembles this,โ replied Spargo. The two men recognized the photograph at once, without any prompting, and Spargo, after a word or two with the landlady, rode off to the Atlantic and Pacific Club, and found Ronald Breton awaiting him on the steps. He made no reference to his recent doings, and together they went into the house and asked for Mr. Aylmore. Spargo looked with more than uncommon interest at the man who presently came to them in the visitorsโ room. He was already familiar with Mr. Aylmoreโs photograph, but he never remembered seeing him in real life; the Member for Brookminster was one of that rapidly diminishing body of legislators whose members are disposed to work quietly and unobtrusively, doing yeoman service on committees, obeying every behest of the party whips, without forcing themselves into the limelight or seizing every opportunity to air their opinions. Now that Spargo met him in the flesh he proved to be pretty much what the journalist had expectedโa rather cold-mannered, self-contained man, who looked as if he had been brought up in a school of rigid repression, and taught not to waste words. He showed no more than the merest of languid interests in Spargo when Breton introduced him, and his face was quite expressionless when Spargo brought to an end his brief explanation โpurposely shortenedโof his object in calling upon him. โYes,โ he said indifferently. โYes, it is quite true that I met Marbury and spent a little time with him on the evening your informant spoke of. I met him, as he told you, in the lobby of the House. I was much surprised to meet him. I had not seen him forโI really donโt know how many years.โ He paused and looked at Spargo as if he was wondering what he ought or not to say to a newspaper man. Spargo remained silent, waiting. And presently Mr. Aylmore went on. โI read your account in the _Watchman_ this morning,โ he said. โI was wondering, when you called just now, if I would communicate with you or with the police. The fact isโI suppose you want this for your paper, eh?โ he continued after a sudden breaking off. โI shall not print anything that you wish me not to print,โ answered Spargo. โIf you care to give me any informationโโโ โOh, well!โ said Mr. Aylmore. โI donโt mind. The fact is, I knew next to nothing. Marbury was a man with whom I had someโwell, business relations, of a sort, a great many years ago. It must be twenty yearsโperhaps moreโsince I lost sight of him. When he came up to me in the lobby the other night, I had to make an effort of memory to recall him. He wished me, having once met me, to give him some advice, and as there was little doing in the House that night, and as he had once beenโalmost a friendโI walked to his hotel with him, chatting. He told me that he had only landed from Australia that morning, and what he wanted my advice about, principally, wasโdiamonds. Australian diamonds.โ โI was unaware,โ remarked Spargo, โthat diamonds were ever found in Australia.โ Mr. Aylmore smiledโa little cynically. โPerhaps so,โ he said. โBut diamonds have been found in Australia from time to time, ever since Australia was known to Europeans, and in the opinion of experts, they will eventually be found there in quantity. Anyhow, Marbury had got hold of some Australian diamonds, and he showed them to me at his hotelโa number of them. We examined them in his room.โ โWhat did he do with themโafterwards?โ asked Spargo. โHe put them in his waistcoat pocketโin a very small wash-leather bag, from which he had taken them. There were, in all, sixteen or twenty stonesโnot more, and they were all small. I advised him to see some expertโI mentioned Streeterโs to him. Now, I can tell you how he got hold of Mr. Bretonโs address.โ The two young men pricked up their ears. Spargo unconsciously tightened his hold on the pencil with which he was making notes. โHe got it from me,โ continued Mr. Aylmore. โThe handwriting on the scrap of paper is mine, hurriedly scrawled. He wanted legal advice. As I knew very little about lawyers, I told him that if he called on Mr. Breton, Mr. Breton would be able to tell him of a first-class, sharp solicitor. I wrote down Mr. Bretonโs address for him, on a scrap of paper which he tore off a letter that he took from his pocket. By the by, I observe that when his body was found there was nothing on it in the shape of papers or money. I am quite sure that when I left him he had a lot of gold on him, those diamonds, and a breast-pocket full of letters.โ โWhere did you leave him, sir?โ asked Spargo. โYou left the hotel together, I believe?โ โYes. We strolled along when we left it. Having once met, we had much to talk of, and it was a fine night. We walked across Waterloo Bridge and very shortly afterwards he left me. And that is really all I know. My own impressionโโโ He paused for a moment and Spargo waited silently. โMy own impressionโthough I confess it may seem to have no very solid groundsโis that Marbury was decoyed to where he was found, and was robbed and murdered by some person who knew he had valuables on him. There is the fact that he was robbed, at any rate.โ โIโve had a notion,โ said Breton, diffidently. โMaynโt be worth much, but Iโve had it, all the same. Some fellow-passenger of Marburyโs may have tracked him all dayโMiddle Temple Laneโs pretty lonely at night, you know.โ No one made any comment upon this suggestion, and on Spargo looking at Mr. Aylmore, the Member of Parliament rose and glanced at the door. โWell, thatโs all I can tell you, Mr. Spargo,โ he said. โYou see, itโs not much, after all. Of course, thereโll be an inquest on Marbury, and I shall have to re-tell it. But youโre welcome to print what Iโve told you.โ Spargo left Breton with his future father-in-law and went away towards New Scotland Yard. He and Rathbury had promised to share newsโnow he had some to communicate. Chapter 8 – The Man from the Safe Deposit. Spargo found Rathbury sitting alone in a small, somewhat dismal apartment which was chiefly remarkable for the business-like paucity of its furnishings and its indefinable air of secrecy. There was a plain writing-table and a hard chair or two; a map of London, much discoloured, on the wall; a few faded photographs of eminent bands in the world of crime, and a similar number of well-thumbed books of reference. The detective himself, when Spargo was shown in to him, was seated at the table, chewing an unlighted cigar, and engaged in the apparently aimless task of drawing hieroglyphics on scraps of paper. He looked up as the journalist entered, and held out his hand. โWell, I congratulate you on what you stuck in the _Watchman_ this morning,โ he said. โMade extra good reading, I thought. They did right to let you tackle that job. Going straight through with it now, I suppose, Mr. Spargo?โ Spargo dropped into the chair nearest to Rathburyโs right hand. He lighted a cigarette, and having blown out a whiff of smoke, nodded his head in a fashion which indicated that the detective might consider his question answered in the affirmative. โLook here,โ he said. โWe settled yesterday, didnโt we, that you and I are to consider ourselves partners, as it were, in this job? Thatโs all right,โ he continued, as Rathbury nodded very quietly. โVery wellโhave you made any further progress?โ Rathbury put his thumbs in the armholes of his waistcoat and, leaning back in his chair, shook his head. โFrankly, I havenโt,โ he replied. โOf course, thereโs a lot being done in the usual official-routine way. Weโve men out making various enquiries. Weโre enquiring about Marburyโs voyage to England. All that we know up to now is that he was certainly a passenger on a liner which landed at Southampton in accordance with what he told those people at the Anglo-Orient, that he left the ship in the usual way and was understood to take the train to townโas he did. Thatโs all. Thereโs nothing in that. Weโve cabled to Melbourne for any news of him from there. But I expect little from that.โ โAll right,โ said Spargo. โAndโwhat are you doingโyou, yourself? Because, if weโre to share facts, I must know what my partnerโs after. Just now, you seemed to beโdrawing.โ Rathbury laughed. โWell, to tell you the truth,โ he said, โwhen I want to work things out, I come into this roomโitโs quiet, as you seeโand I scribble anything on paper while I think. I was figuring on my next step, andโโ โDo you see it?โ asked Spargo, quickly. โWellโI want to find the man who went with Marbury to that hotel,โ replied Rathbury. โIt seems to meโโ Spargo wagged his finger at his fellow-contriver. โIโve found him,โ he said. โThatโs what I wrote that article forโto find him. I knew it would find him. Iโve never had any training in your sort of work, but I knew that article would get him. And it has got him.โ Rathbury accorded the journalist a look of admiration. โGood!โ he said. โAndโwho is he?โ โIโll tell you the story,โ answered Spargo, โand in a summary. This morning a man named Webster, a farmer, a visitor to London, came to me at the office, and said that being at the House of Commons last night he witnessed a meeting between Marbury and a man who was evidently a Member of Parliament, and saw them go away together. I showed him an album of photographs of the present members, and he immediately recognized the portrait of one of them as the man in question. I thereupon took the portrait to the Anglo-Orient HotelโMrs. Walters also at once recognized it as that of the man who came to the hotel with Marbury, stopped with him a while in his room, and left with him. The man is Mr. Stephen Aylmore, the member for Brookminster.โ Rathbury expressed his feelings in a sharp whistle. โI know him!โ he said. โOf courseโI remember Mrs. Waltersโs description now. But his is a familiar typeโtall, grey-bearded, well-dressed. Um!โwell, weโll have to see Mr. Aylmore at once.โ โIโve seen him,โ said Spargo. โNaturally! For you see, Mrs. Walters gave me a bit more evidence. This morning they found a loose diamond on the floor of Number 20, and after it was found the waiter who took the drinks up to Marbury and his guest that night remembered that when he entered the room the two gentlemen were looking at a paper full of similar objects. So then I went on to see Mr. Aylmore. You know young Breton, the barrister?โyou met him with me, you remember?โ โThe young fellow whose name and address were found on Marbury,โ replied Rathbury. โI remember.โ โBreton is engaged to Aylmoreโs daughter,โ continued Spargo. โBreton took me to Aylmoreโs club. And Aylmore gives a plain, straightforward account of the matter which heโs granted me leave to print. It clears up a lot of things. Aylmore knew Marbury over twenty years ago. He lost sight of him. They met accidentally in the lobby of the House on the evening preceding the murder. Marbury told him that he wanted his advice about those rare things, Australian diamonds. He went back with him to his hotel and spent a while with him; then they walked out together as far as Waterloo Bridge, where Aylmore left him and went home. Further, the scrap of grey paper is accounted for. Marbury wanted the address of a smart solicitor; Aylmore didnโt know of one but told Marbury that if he called on young Breton, heโd know, and would put him in the way to find one. Marbury wrote Bretonโs address down. Thatโs Aylmoreโs story. But itโs got an important addition. Aylmore says that when he left Marbury, Marbury had on him a quantity of those diamonds in a wash-leather bag, a lot of gold, and a breast-pocket full of letters and papers. Nowโthere was nothing on him when he was found dead in Middle Temple Lane.โ Spargo stopped and lighted a fresh cigarette. โThatโs all I know,โ he said. โWhat do you make of it?โ Rathbury leaned back in his chair in his apparently favourite attitude and stared hard at the dusty ceiling above him. โDonโt know,โ he said. โIt brings things up to a point, certainly. Aylmore and Marbury parted at Waterloo Bridgeโvery late. Waterloo Bridge is pretty well next door to the Temple. Butโhow did Marbury get into the Temple, unobserved? Weโve made every enquiry, and we canโt trace him in any way as regards that movement. Thereโs a clue for his going there in the scrap of paper bearing Bretonโs address, but even a Colonial would know that no business was done in the Temple at midnight, eh?โ โWell,โ said Spargo, โIโve thought of one or two things. He may have been one of those men who like to wander around at night. He may have seenโhe would seeโplenty of lights in the Temple at that hour; he may have slipped in unobservedโitโs possible, itโs quite possible. I once had a moonlight saunter in the Temple myself after midnight, and had no difficulty about walking in and out, either. Butโif Marbury was murdered for the sake of what he had on himโhow did he meet with his murderer or murderers in there? Criminals donโt hang about Middle Temple Lane.โ The detective shook his head. He picked up his pencil and began making more hieroglyphics. โWhatโs your theory, Mr. Spargo?โ he asked suddenly. โI suppose youโve got one.โ โHave you?โ asked Spargo, bluntly. โWell,โ returned Rathbury, hesitatingly, โI hadnโt, up to now. But nowโnow, after what youโve told me, I think I can make one. It seems to me that after Marbury left Aylmore he probably mooned about by himself, that he was decoyed into the Temple, and was there murdered and robbed. There are a lot of queer ins and outs, nooks and corners in that old spot, Mr. Spargo, and the murderer, if he knew his ground well, could easily hide himself until he could get away in the morning. He might be a man who had access to chambers or officesโthink how easy it would be for such a man, having once killed and robbed his victim, to lie hid for hours afterwards? For aught we know, the man who murdered Marbury may have been within twenty feet of you when you first saw his dead body that morning. Eh?โ Before Spargo could reply to this suggestion an official entered the room and whispered a few words in the detectiveโs ear. โShow him in at once,โ said Rathbury. He turned to Spargo as the man quitted the room and smiled significantly. โHereโs somebody wants to tell something about the Marbury case,โ he remarked. โLetโs hope itโll be news worth hearing.โ Spargo smiled in his queer fashion. โIt strikes me that youโve only got to interest an inquisitive public in order to get news,โ he said. โThe principal thing is to investigate it when youโve got it. Whoโs this, now?โ The official had returned with a dapper-looking gentleman in a frock-coat and silk hat, bearing upon him the unmistakable stamp of the city man, who inspected Rathbury with deliberation and Spargo with a glance, and being seated turned to the detective as undoubtedly the person he desired to converse with. โI understand that you are the officer in charge of the Marbury murder case,โ he observed. โI believe I can give you some valuable information in respect to that. I read the account of the affair in the _Watchman_ newspaper this morning, and saw the portrait of the murdered man there, and I was at first inclined to go to the _Watchman_ office with my information, but I finally decided to approach the police instead of the Press, regarding the police as being moreโmore responsible.โ โMuch obliged to you, sir,โ said Rathbury, with a glance at Spargo. โWhom have I the pleasure ofโโโ โMy name,โ replied the visitor, drawing out and laying down a card, โis MyerstโMr. E.P. Myerst, Secretary of the London and Universal Safe Deposit Company. I may, I suppose, speak with confidence,โ continued Mr. Myerst, with a side-glance at Spargo. โMy information isโconfidential.โ Rathbury inclined his head and put his fingers together. โYou may speak with every confidence, Mr. Myerst,โ he answered. โIf what you have to tell has any real bearing on the Marbury case, it will probably have to be repeated in public, you know, sir. But at present it will be treated as private.โ โIt has a very real bearing on the case, I should say,โ replied Mr. Myerst. โYes, I should decidedly say so. The fact is that on June 21st at aboutโto be preciseโthree oโclock in the afternoon, a stranger, who gave the name of John Marbury, and his present address as the Anglo-Orient Hotel, Waterloo, called at our establishment, and asked if he could rent a small safe. He explained to me that he desired to deposit in such a safe a small leather boxโwhich, by the by, was of remarkably ancient appearanceโthat he had brought with him. I showed him a safe such as he wanted, informed him of the rent, and of the rules of the place, and he engaged the safe, paid the rent for one year in advance, and deposited his leather boxโan affair of about a foot squareโthere and then. After that, having exchanged a remark or two about the altered conditions of London, which, I understood him to say, he had not seen for a great many years, he took his key and his departure. I think there can be no doubt about this being the Mr. Marbury who was found murdered.โ โNone at all, I should say, Mr. Myerst,โ said Rathbury. โAnd Iโm much obliged to you for coming here. Now you might tell me a little more, sir. Did Marbury tell you anything about the contents of the box?โ โNo. He merely remarked that he wished the greatest care to be taken of it,โ replied the secretary. โDidnโt give you any hint as to what was in it?โ asked Rathbury. โNone. But he was very particular to assure himself that it could not be burnt, nor burgled, nor otherwise molested,โ replied Mr. Myerst. โHe appeared to be greatly relieved when he found that it was impossible for anyone but himself to take his property from his safe.โ โAh!โ said Rathbury, winking at Spargo. โSo he would, no doubt. And Marbury himself, sir, now? How did he strike you?โ Mr. Myerst gravely considered this question. โMr. Marbury struck me,โ he answered at last, โas a man who had probably seen strange places. And before leaving he made, what I will term, a remarkable remark. Aboutโin fact, about his leather box.โ โHis leather box?โ said Rathbury. โAnd what was it, sir?โ โThis,โ replied the secretary. โโThat box,โ he said, โis safe now. But itโs been safer. Itโs been buriedโand deep-down, tooโfor many and many a year!โโ Chapter 9 – The Dealer in Rare Stamps. โBuriedโand deep-down, tooโfor many and many a year,โ repeated Mr. Myerst, eyeing his companions with keen glances. โI consider that, gentlemen, a very remarkable remarkโvery remarkable!โ Rathbury stuck his thumbs in the armholes of his waistcoat again and began swaying backwards and forwards in his chair. He looked at Spargo. And with his knowledge of men, he knew that all Spargoโs journalistic instincts had been aroused, and that he was keen as mustard to be off on a new scent. โRemarkableโremarkable, Mr. Myerst!โ he assented. โWhat do you say, Mr. Spargo?โ Spargo turned slowly, and for the first time since Myerst had entered made a careful inspection of him. The inspection lasted several seconds; then Spargo spoke. โAnd what did you say to that?โ he asked quietly. Myerst looked from his questioner to Rathbury. And Rathbury thought it time to enlighten the caller. โI may as well tell you, Mr. Myerst,โ he said smilingly, โthat this is Mr. Spargo, of the _Watchman_. Mr. Spargo wrote the article about the Marbury case of which you spoke when you came in. Mr. Spargo, youโll gather, is deeply interested in this matterโand he and I, in our different capacities, are working together. Soโyou understand?โ Myerst regarded Spargo in a new light. And while he was so looking at him. Spargo repeated the question he had just put. โI saidโWhat did you say to that?โ Myerst hesitated. โWellโerโI donโt think I said anything,โ he replied. โNothing that one might call material, you know.โ โDidnโt ask him what he meant?โ suggested Spargo. โOh, noโnot at all,โ replied Myerst. Spargo got up abruptly from his chair. โThen you missed one of the finest opportunities I ever heard of!โ he said, half-sneeringly. โYou might have heard such a storyโโ He paused, as if it were not worth while to continue, and turned to Rathbury, who was regarding him with amusement. โLook here, Rathbury,โ he said. โIs it possible to get that box opened?โ โItโll have to be opened,โ answered Rathbury, rising. โItโs got to be opened. It probably contains the clue we want. Iโm going to ask Mr. Myerst here to go with me just now to take the first steps about having it opened. I shall have to get an order. We may get the matter through today, but at any rate weโll have it done tomorrow morning.โ โCan you arrange for me to be present when that comes off?โ asked Spargo. โYou canโcertain? Thatโs all right, Rathbury. Now Iโm off, and youโll ring me up or come round if you hear anything, and Iโll do the same by you.โ And without further word, Spargo went quickly away, and just as quickly returned to the _Watchman_ office. There the assistant who had been told off to wait upon his orders during this new crusade met him with a business card. โThis gentleman came in to see you about an hour ago, Mr. Spargo,โ he said. โHe thinks he can tell you something about the Marbury affair, and he said that as he couldnโt wait, perhaps youโd step round to his place when you came in.โ Spargo took the card and read: MR. JAMES CRIEDIR, DEALER IN PHILATELIC RARITIES, 2,021, STRAND. Spargo put the card in his waistcoat pocket and went out again, wondering why Mr. James Criedir could not, would not, or did not call himself a dealer in rare postage stamps, and so use plain English. He went up Fleet Street and soon found the shop indicated on the card, and his first glance at its exterior showed that whatever business might have been done by Mr. Criedir in the past at that establishment there was to be none done there in the future by him, for there were newly-printed bills in the window announcing that the place was to let. And inside he found a short, portly, elderly man who was superintending the packing-up and removal of the last of his stock. He turned a bright, enquiring eye on the journalist. โMr. Criedir?โ said Spargo. โThe same, sir,โ answered the philatelist. โYou areโ?โ โMr. Spargo, of the _Watchman_. You called on me.โ Mr. Criedir opened the door of a tiny apartment at the rear of the very little shop and motioned his caller to enter. He followed him in and carefully closed the door. โGlad to see you, Mr. Spargo,โ he said genially. โTake a seat, sirโIโm all in confusion hereโgiving up business, you see. Yes, I called on you. I think, having read the _Watchman_ account of that Marbury affair, and having seen the murdered manโs photograph in your columns, that I can give you a bit of information.โ โMaterial?โ asked Spargo, tersely. Mr. Criedir cocked one of his bright eyes at his visitor. He coughed drily. โThatโs for you to decideโwhen youโve heard it,โ he said. โI should say, considering everything, that it was material. Well, itโs thisโI kept open until yesterdayโeverything as usual, you knowโstock in the window and so onโso that anybody who was passing would naturally have thought that the business was going on, though as a matter of fact, Iโm retiringโretired,โ added Mr. Criedir with a laugh, โlast night. Nowโbut wonโt you take down what Iโve got to tell you?โ โI am taking it down,โ answered Spargo. โEvery word. In my head.โ Mr. Criedir laughed and rubbed his hands. โOh!โ he said. โAh, well, in my young days journalists used to pull out pencil and notebook at the first opportunity. But you modern young menโโ โJust so,โ agreed Spargo. โThis information, now?โ โWell,โ said Mr. Criedir, โweโll go on then. Yesterday afternoon the man described as Marbury came into my shop. Heโโ โWhat timeโexact time?โ asked Spargo. โTwoโto the very minute by St. Clement Danes clock,โ answered Mr. Criedir. โIโd swear twenty affidavits on that point. He was precisely as youโve described himโdress, everythingโI tell you I knew his photo as soon as I saw it. He was carrying a little boxโโ โWhat sort of box?โ said Spargo. โA queer, old-fashioned, much-worn leather boxโa very miniature trunk, in fact,โ replied Mr. Criedir. โAbout a foot square; the sort of thing you never see nowadays. It was very much worn; it attracted me for that very reason. He set it on the counter and looked at me. โYouโre a dealer in stampsโrare stamps?โ he said. โI am,โ I replied. โIโve something here Iโd like to show you,โ he said, unlocking the box. โItโsโโโ โStop a bit,โ said Spargo. โWhere did he take the key from with which he unlocked the box?โ โIt was one of several which he carried on a split ring, and he took the bunch out of his left-hand trousers pocket,โ replied Mr. Criedir. โOh, I keep my eyes open, young gentleman! Wellโhe opened his box. It seemed to me to be full of papersโat any rate there were a lot of legal-looking documents on the top, tied up with red tape. To show you how I notice things I saw that the papers were stained with age, and that the red tape was faded to a mere washed-out pink.โ โGoodโgood!โ murmured Spargo. โExcellent! Proceed, sir. โ โHe put his hand under the topmost papers and drew out an envelope,โ continued Mr. Criedir. โFrom the envelope he produced an exceedingly rare, exceedingly valuable set of Colonial stampsโthe very-first ever issued. โIโve just come from Australia,โ he said. โI promised a young friend of mine out there to sell these stamps for him in London, and as I was passing this way I caught sight of your shop. Will you buy ’em, and how much will you give for ’em?โโ โPrompt,โ muttered Spargo. โHe seemed to me the sort of man who doesnโt waste words,โ agreed Mr. Criedir. โWell, there was no doubt about the stamps, nor about their great value. But I had to explain to him that I was retiring from business that very day, and did not wish to enter into even a single deal, and that, therefore, I couldnโt do anything. โNo matter,โ he says, โI daresay there are lots of men in your line of tradeโperhaps you can recommend me to a good firm?โ โI could recommend you to a dozen extra-good firms,โ I answered. โBut I can do better for you. Iโll give you the name and address of a private buyer who, I havenโt the least doubt, will be very glad to buy that set from you and will give you a big price.โ โWrite it down,โ he says, โand thank you for your trouble.โ So I gave him a bit of advice as to the price he ought to get, and I wrote the name and address of the man I referred to on the back of one of my cards.โ โWhose name and address?โ asked Spargo. โMr. Nicholas Cardlestone, 2, Pilcox Buildings, Middle Temple Lane,โ replied Mr. Criedir. โMr. Cardlestone is one of the most enthusiastic and accomplished philatelists in Europe. And I knew he didnโt possess that set of stamps.โ โI know Mr. Cardlestone,โ remarked Spargo. โIt was at the foot of his stairs that Marbury was found murdered.โ โJust so,โ said Mr. Criedir. โWhich makes me think that he was going to see Mr. Cardlestone when he was set upon, murdered, and robbed.โ Spargo looked fixedly at the retired stamp-dealer. โWhat, going to see an elderly gentleman in his rooms in the Temple, to offer to sell him philatelic rarities atโpast midnight?โ he said. โI thinkโnot much!โ โAll right,โ replied Mr. Criedir. โYou think and argue on modern linesโwhich are, of course, highly superior. Butโhow do you account for my having given Marbury Mr. Cardlestoneโs address and for his having been found deadโmurderedโat the foot of Cardlestoneโs stairs a few hours later?โ โI donโt account for it,โ said Spargo. โIโm trying to.โ Mr. Criedir made no comment on this. He looked his visitor up and down for a moment; gathered some idea of his capabilities, and suddenly offered him a cigarette. Spargo accepted it with a laconic word of thanks, and smoked half-way through it before he spoke again. โYes,โ he said. โIโm trying to account. And I shall account. And Iโm much obliged to you, Mr. Criedir, for what youโve told me. Now, then, may I ask you a question or two?โ โA thousand!โ responded Mr. Criedir with great geniality. โVery well. Did Marbury say heโd call on Cardlestone?โ โHe did. Said heโd call as soon as he couldโthat day.โ โHave you told Cardlestone what youโve just told me?โ โI have. But not until an hour agoโon my way back from your office, in fact. I met him in Fleet Street and told him.โ โHad he received a call from Marbury?โ โNo! Never heard of or seen the man. At least, never heard of him until he heard of the murder. He told me he and his friend, Mr. Elphick, another philatelist, went to see the body, wondering if they could recognize it as any man theyโd ever known, but they couldnโt.โ โI know they did,โ said Spargo. โI saw ’em at the mortuary. Um! Wellโone more question. When Marbury left you, did he put those stamps in his box again, as before?โ โNo,โ replied Mr. Criedir. โHe put them in his right-hand breast pocket, and he locked up his old box, and went off swinging it in his left hand.โ Spargo went away down Fleet Street, seeing nobody. He muttered to himself, and he was still muttering when he got into his room at the office. And what he muttered was the same thing, repeated over and over again: โSix hoursโsix hoursโsix hours! Those six hours!โ Next morning the _Watchman_ came out with four leaded columns of up-to-date news about the Marbury Case, and right across the top of the four ran a heavy double line of great capitals, black and staring:โWHO SAW JOHN MARBURY BETWEEN 3.15 P.M. AND 9.15 P.M. ON THE DAY PRECEDING HIS MURDER? Chapter 10 – The Leather Box. Whether Spargo was sanguine enough to expect that his staring headline would bring him information of the sort he wanted was a secret which he kept to himself. That a good many thousands of human beings must have set eyes on John Marbury between the hours which Spargo set forth in that headline was certain; the problem wasโWhat particular owner or owners of a pair or of many pairs of those eyes would remember him? Why should they remember him? Walters and his wife had reason to remember him; Criedir had reason to remember him; so had Myerst; so had William Webster. But between a quarter past three, when he left the London and Universal Safe Deposit, and a quarter past nine, when he sat down by Websterโs side in the lobby of the House of Commons, nobody seemed to have any recollection of him except Mr. Fiskie, the hatter, and he only remembered him faintly, and because Marbury had bought a fashionable cloth cap at his shop. At any rate, by noon of that day, nobody had come forward with any recollection of him. He must have gone West from seeing Myerst, because he bought his cap at Fiskieโs; he must eventually have gone South-West, because he turned up at Westminster. But where else did he go? What did he do? To whom did he speak? No answer came to these questions. โThat shows,โ observed young Mr. Ronald Breton, lazing an hour away in Spargoโs room at the _Watchman_ at that particular hour which is neither noon nor afternoon, wherein even busy men do nothing, โthat shows how a chap can go about London as if he were merely an ant that had strayed into another ant-heap than his own. Nobody notices.โ โYouโd better go and read up a little elementary entomology, Breton,โ said Spargo. โI donโt know much about it myself, but Iโve a pretty good idea that when an ant walks into the highways and byways of a colony to which he doesnโt belong he doesnโt survive his intrusion by many seconds.โ โWell, you know what I mean,โ said Breton. โLondonโs an ant-heap, isnโt it? One human ant more or less doesnโt count. This man Marbury must have gone about a pretty tidy lot during those six hours. Heโd ride on a โbusโalmost certain. Heโd get into a taxi-cabโI think thatโs much more certain, because it would be a novelty to him. Heโd want some teaโanyway, heโd be sure to want a drink, and heโd turn in somewhere to get one or the other. Heโd buy things in shopsโthese Colonials always do. Heโd go somewhere to get his dinner. Heโdโbut whatโs the use of enumeration in this case?โ โA mere piling up of platitudes,โ answered Spargo. โWhat I mean is,โ continued Breton, โthat piles of people must have seen him, and yet itโs now hours and hours since your paper came out this morning, and nobodyโs come forward to tell anything. And when you come to think of it, why should they? Whoโd remember an ordinary man in a grey tweed suit?โ โโAn ordinary man in a grey tweed suit,โโ repeated Spargo. โGood line. You havenโt any copyright in it, remember. It would make a good cross-heading.โ Breton laughed. โYouโre a queer chap, Spargo,โ he said. โSeriously, do you think youโre getting any nearer anything?โ โIโm getting nearer something with everything thatโs done,โ Spargo answered. โYou canโt start on a business like this without evolving something out of it, you know.โ โWell,โ said Breton, โto me thereโs not so much mystery in it. Mr. Aylmoreโs explained the reason why my address was found on the body; Criedir, the stamp-man, has explainedโโ Spargo suddenly looked up. โWhat?โ he said sharply. โWhy, the reason of Marburyโs being found where he was found,โ replied Breton. โOf course, I see it all! Marbury was mooning around Fleet Street; he slipped into Middle Temple Lane, late as it was, just to see where old Cardlestone hangs out, and he was set upon and done for. The thingโs plain to me. The only thing now is to find who did it.โ โYes, thatโs it,โ agreed Spargo. โThatโs it.โ He turned over the leaves of the diary which lay on his desk. โBy the by,โ he said, looking up with some interest, โthe adjourned inquest is at eleven oโclock tomorrow morning. Are you going?โ โI shall certainly go,โ answered Breton. โWhatโs more, Iโm going to take Miss Aylmore and her sister. As the gruesome details were over at the first sitting, and as thereโll be nothing but this new evidence tomorrow, and as theyโve never been in a coronerโs courtโโโ โMr. Aylmoreโll be the principal witness tomorrow,โ interrupted Spargo. โI suppose heโll be able to tell a lot more than he toldโme.โ Breton shrugged his shoulders. โI donโt see that thereโs much more to tell,โ he said. โBut,โ he added, with a sly laugh, โI suppose you want some more good copy, eh?โ Spargo glanced at his watch, rose, and picked up his hat. โIโll tell you what I want,โ he said. โI want to know who John Marbury was. That would make good copy. Who he wasโtwentyโtwenty-fiveโforty years ago. Eh?โ โAnd you think Mr. Aylmore can tell?โ asked Breton. โMr. Aylmore,โ answered Spargo as they walked towards the door, โis the only person I have met so far who has admitted that he knew John Marbury in theโpast. But he didnโt tell meโmuch. Perhaps heโll tell the coroner and his juryโmore. Now, Iโm off BretonโIโve an appointment.โ And leaving Breton to find his own way out, Spargo hurried away, jumped into a taxi-cab and speeded to the London and Universal Safe Deposit. At the corner of its building he found Rathbury awaiting him. โWell?โ said Spargo, as he sprang out: โHow is it?โ โItโs all right,โ answered Rathbury. โYou can be present: I got the necessary permission. As there are no relations known, thereโll only be one or two officials and you, and the Safe Deposit people, and myself. Come onโitโs about time.โ โIt sounds,โ observed Spargo, โlike an exhumation.โ Rathbury laughed. โWell, weโre certainly going to dig up a dead manโs secrets,โ he said. โAt least, we may be going to do so. In my opinion, Mr. Spargo, weโll find some clue in this leather box.โ Spargo made no answer. They entered the office, to be shown into a room where were already assembled Mr. Myerst, a gentleman who turned out to be the chairman of the company, and the officials of whom Rathbury had spoken. And in another moment Spargo heard the chairman explaining that the company possessed duplicate keys to all safes, and that the proper authorization having been received from the proper authorities, those present would now proceed to the safe recently tenanted by the late Mr. John Marbury, and take from it the property which he himself had deposited there, a small leather box, which they would afterwards bring to that room and cause to be opened in each otherโs presence. It seemed to Spargo that there was an unending unlocking of bolts and bars before he and his fellow-processionists came to the safe so recently rented by the late Mr. John Marbury, now undoubtedly deceased. And at first sight of it, he saw that it was so small an affair that it seemed ludicrous to imagine that it could contain anything of any importance. In fact, it looked to be no more than a plain wooden locker, one amongst many in a small strong room: it reminded Spargo irresistibly of the locker in which, in his school days, he had kept his personal belongings and the jam tarts, sausage rolls, and hardbake smuggled in from the tuck-shop. Marburyโs name had been newly painted upon it; the paint was scarcely dry. But when the wooden doorโthe front door, as it were, of this temple of mystery, had been solemnly opened by the chairman, a formidable door of steel was revealed, and expectation still leapt in the bosoms of the beholders. โThe duplicate key, Mr. Myerst, if you please,โ commanded the chairman, โthe duplicate key!โ Myerst, who was fully as solemn as his principal, produced a curious-looking key: the chairman lifted his hand as if he were about to christen a battleship: the steel door swung slowly back. And there, in a two-foot square cavity, lay the leather box. It struck Spargo as they filed back to the secretaryโs room that the procession became more funereal-like than ever. First walked the chairman, abreast with the high official, who had brought the necessary authorization from the all-powerful quarter; then came Myerst carrying the box: followed two other gentlemen, both legal lights, charged with watching official and police interests; Rathbury and Spargo brought up the rear. He whispered something of his notions to the detective; Rathbury nodded a comprehensive understanding. โLetโs hope weโre going to seeโsomething!โ he said. In the secretaryโs room a man waited who touched his forelock respectfully as the heads of the procession entered. Myerst set the box on the table: the man made a musical jingle of keys: the other members of the procession gathered round. โAs we naturally possess no key to this box,โ announced the chairman in grave tones, โit becomes our duty to employ professional assistance in opening it. Jobson!โ He waved a hand, and the man of the keys stepped forward with alacrity. He examined the lock of the box with a knowing eye; it was easy to see that he was anxious to fall upon it. While he considered matters, Spargo looked at the box. It was pretty much what it had been described to him as being; a small, square box of old cow-hide, very strongly made, much worn and tarnished, fitted with a handle projecting from the lid, and having the appearance of having been hidden away somewhere for many a long day. There was a click, a spring: Jobson stepped back. โThatโs it, if you please, sir,โ he said. The chairman motioned to the high official. โIf you would be good enough to open the box, sir,โ he said. โOur duty is now concluded.โ As the high official laid his hand on the lid the other men gathered round with craning necks and expectant eyes. The lid was lifted: somebody sighed deeply. And Spargo pushed his own head and eyes nearer. The box was empty! Empty, as anything that can be empty is empty! thought Spargo: there was literally nothing in it. They were all staring into the interior of a plain, time-worn little receptacle, lined out with old-fashioned chintz stuff, such as our Mid-Victorian fore-fathers were familiar with, and containingโnothing. โGod bless my soul!โ exclaimed the chairman. โThis isโdear me!โwhy, there is nothing in the box!โ โThat,โ remarked the high official, drily, โappears to be obvious.โ The chairman looked at the secretary. โI understood the box was valuable, Mr. Myerst,โ he said, with the half-injured air of a man who considers himself to have been robbed of an exceptionally fine treat. โValuable!โ Myerst coughed. โI can only repeat what I have already said, Sir Benjamin,โ he answered. โTheโer late Mr. Marbury spoke of the deposit as being of great value to him; he never permitted it out of his hand until he placed it in the safe. He appeared to regard it as of the greatest value.โ โBut we understand from the evidence of Mr. Criedir, given to the _Watchman_ newspaper, that it was full of papers andโand other articles,โ said the chairman. โCriedir saw papers in it about an hour before it was brought here.โ Myerst spread out his hands. โI can only repeat what I have said, Sir Benjamin,โ he answered. โI know nothing more.โ โBut why should a man deposit an empty box?โ began the chairman. โIโโ The high official interposed. โThat the box is empty is certain,โ he observed. โDid you ever handle it yourself, Mr. Myerst?โ Myerst smiled in a superior fashion. โI have already observed, sir, that from the time the deceased entered this room until the moment he placed the box in the safe which he rented, the box was never out of his hands,โ he replied. Then there was silence. At last the high official turned to the chairman. โVery well,โ he said. โWeโve made the enquiry. Rathbury, take the box away with you and lock it up at the Yard.โ So Spargo went out with Rathbury and the box; and saw excellent, if mystifying, material for the article which had already become the daily feature of his paper. Chapter 11 – Mr. Aylmore is Questioned. It seemed to Spargo as he sat listening to the proceedings at the adjourned inquest next day that the whole story of what was now world-famous as the Middle Temple Murder Case was being reiterated before him for the thousandth time. There was not a detail of the story with which he had not become familiar to fulness. The first proceeding before the coroner had been of a merely formal nature; these were thorough and exhaustive; the representative of the Crown and twelve good men and true of the City of London were there to hear and to find out and to arrive at a conclusion as to how the man known as John Marbury came by his death. And although he knew all about it, Spargo found himself tabulating the evidence in a professional manner, and noting how each successive witness contributed, as it were, a chapter to the story. The story itself ran quite easily, naturally, consecutivelyโyou could make it in sections. And Spargo, sitting merely to listen, made them: 1. The Temple porter and Constable Driscoll proved the finding of the body. 2. The police surgeon testified as to the cause of deathโthe man had been struck down from behind by a blow, a terrible blowโfrom some heavy instrument, and had died immediately. 3. The police and the mortuary officials proved that when the body was examined nothing was found in the clothing but the now famous scrap of grey paper. 4. Rathbury proved that by means of the dead manโs new fashionable cloth cap, bought at Fiskieโs well-known shop in the West-End, he traced Marbury to the Anglo-Orient Hotel in the Waterloo District. 5. Mr. and Mrs. Walters gave evidence of the arrival of Marbury at the Anglo-Orient Hotel, and of his doings while he was in and about there. 6. The purser of the ss. _Wambarino_ proved that Marbury sailed from Melbourne to Southampton on that ship, excited no remark, behaved himself like any other well-regulated passenger, and left the _Wambarino_ at Southampton early in the morning of what was to be the last day of his life in just the ordinary manner. 7. Mr. Criedir gave evidence of his rencontre with Marbury in the matter of the stamps. 8. Mr. Myerst told of Marburyโs visit to the Safe Deposit, and further proved that the box which he placed there proved, on official examination, to be empty. 9. William Webster re-told the story of his encounter with Marbury in one of the vestibules of the House of Commons, and of his witnessing the meeting between him and the gentleman whom he (Webster) now knew to be Mr. Aylmore, a Member of Parliament. All this led up to the appearance of Mr. Aylmore, M.P., in the witness-box. And Spargo knew and felt that it was that appearance for which the crowded court was waiting. Thanks to his own vivid and realistic specials in the _Watchman_, everybody there had already become well and thoroughly acquainted with the mass of evidence represented by the nine witnesses who had been in the box before Mr. Aylmore entered it. They were familiar, too, with the facts which Mr. Aylmore had permitted Spargo to print after the interview at the club, which Ronald Breton arranged. Why, then, the extraordinary interest which the Member of Parliamentโs appearance aroused? For everybody was extraordinarily interested; from the Coroner downwards to the last man who had managed to squeeze himself into the last available inch of the public gallery, all who were there wanted to hear and see the man who met Marbury under such dramatic circumstances, and who went to his hotel with him, hobnobbed with him, gave him advice, walked out of the hotel with him for a stroll from which Marbury never returned. Spargo knew well why the interest was so keenโeverybody knew that Aylmore was the only man who could tell the court anything really pertinent about Marbury; who he was, what he was after; what his life had been. He looked round the court as the Member of Parliament entered the witness-boxโa tall, handsome, perfectly-groomed man, whose beard was only slightly tinged with grey, whose figure was as erect as a well-drilled soldierโs, who carried about him an air of conscious power. Aylmoreโs two daughters sat at a little distance away, opposite Spargo, with Ronald Breton in attendance upon them; Spargo had encountered their glance as they entered the court, and they had given him a friendly nod and smile. He had watched them from time to time; it was plain to him that they regarded the whole affair as a novel sort of entertainment; they might have been idlers in some Eastern bazaar, listening to the unfolding of many tales from the professional tale-tellers. Now, as their father entered the box, Spargo looked at them again; he saw nothing more than a little heightening of colour in their cheeks, a little brightening of their eyes. โAll that they feel,โ he thought, โis a bit of extra excitement at the idea that their father is mixed up in this delightful mystery. Um! Wellโnow how much is he mixed up?โ And he turned to the witness-box and from that moment never took his eyes off the man who now stood in it. For Spargo had ideas about the witness which he was anxious to develop. The folk who expected something immediately sensational in Mr. Aylmoreโs evidence were disappointed. Aylmore, having been sworn, and asked a question or two by the Coroner, requested permission to tell, in his own way, what he knew of the dead man and of this sad affair; and having received that permission, he went on in a calm, unimpassioned manner to repeat precisely what he had told Spargo. It sounded a very plain, ordinary story. He had known Marbury many years ago. He had lost sight of him forโoh, quite twenty years. He had met him accidentally in one of the vestibules of the House of Commons on the evening preceding the murder. Marbury had asked his advice. Having no particular duty, and willing to do an old acquaintance a good turn, he had gone back to the Anglo-Orient Hotel with Marbury, had remained awhile with him in his room, examining his Australian diamonds, and had afterwards gone out with him. He had given him the advice he wanted; they had strolled across Waterloo Bridge; shortly afterwards they had parted. That was all he knew. The court, the public, Spargo, everybody there, knew all this already. It had been in print, under a big headline, in the _Watchman_. Aylmore had now told it again; having told it, he seemed to consider that his next step was to leave the box and the court, and after a perfunctory question or two from the Coroner and the foreman of the jury he made a motion as if to step down. But Spargo, who had been aware since the beginning of the enquiry of the presence of a certain eminent counsel who represented the Treasury, cocked his eye in that gentlemanโs direction, and was not surprised to see him rise in his well-known, apparently indifferent fashion, fix his monocle in his right eye, and glance at the tall figure in the witness-box. โThe fun is going to begin,โ muttered Spargo. The Treasury representative looked from Aylmore to the Coroner and made a jerky bow; from the Coroner to Aylmore and straightened himself. He looked like a man who is going to ask indifferent questions about the state of the weather, or how Smithโs wife was last time you heard of her, or if stocks are likely to rise or fall. But Spargo had heard this man before, and he knew many signs of his in voice and manner and glance. โI want to ask you a few questions, Mr. Aylmore, about your acquaintanceship with the dead man. It was an acquaintanceship of some time ago?โ began the suave, seemingly careless voice. โA considerable time ago,โ answered Aylmore. โHow longโroughly speaking?โ โI should say from twenty to twenty-two or three years.โ โNever saw him during that time until you met accidentally in the way you have described to us?โ โNever.โ โEver heard from him?โ โNo.โ โEver heard of him?โ โNo.โ โBut when you met, you knew each other at once?โ โWellโalmost at once.โ โAlmost at once. Then, I take it, you were very well known to each other twenty or twenty-two years ago?โ โWe wereโyes, well known to each other.โ โClose friends?โ โI said we were acquaintances.โ โAcquaintances. What was his name when you knew him at that time?โ โHis name? It wasโMarbury.โ โMarburyโthe same name. Where did you know him?โ โIโoh, here in London.โ โWhat was he?โ โDo you meanโwhat was his occupation?โ โWhat was his occupation?โ โI believe he was concerned in financial matters.โ โConcerned in financial matters. Had you dealings with him?โ โWell, yesโon occasions.โ โWhat was his business address in London?โ โI canโt remember that.โ โWhat was his private address?โ โThat I never knew.โ โWhere did you transact your business with him?โ โWell, we met, now and then. โWhere? What place, office, resort?โ โI canโt remember particular places. Sometimesโin the City.โ โIn the City. Where in the City? Mansion House, or Lombard Street, or St. Paulโs Churchyard, or the Old Bailey, or where?โ โI have recollections of meeting him outside the Stock Exchange.โ โOh! Was he a member of that institution?โ โNot that I know of.โ โWere you?โ โCertainly not!โ โWhat were the dealings that you had with him?โ โFinancial dealingsโsmall ones.โ โHow long did your acquaintanceship with him lastโwhat period did it extend over?โ โI should say about six months to nine months.โ โNo more?โ โCertainly no more.โ โIt was quite a slight acquaintanceship, then?โ โOh, quite!โ โAnd yet, after losing sight of this merely slight acquaintance for over twenty years, you, on meeting him, take great interest in him?โ โWell, I was willing to do him a good turn, I was interested in what he told me the other evening.โ โI see. Now you will not object to my asking you a personal question or two. You are a public man, and the facts about the lives of public men are more or less public property. You are represented in this work of popular reference as coming to this country in 1902, from Argentina, where you made a considerable fortune. You have told us, however, that you were in London, acquainted with Marbury, about the years, say 1890 to 1892. Did you then leave England soon after knowing Marbury?โ โI did. I left England in 1891 or 1892โI am not sure which.โ โWe are wanting to be very sure about this matter, Mr. Aylmore. We want to solve the important questionโwho is, who was John Marbury, and how did he come by his death? You seem to be the only available person who knows anything about him. What was your business before you left England?โ โI was interested in financial affairs.โ โLike Marbury. Where did you carry on your business?โ โIn London, of course.โ โAt what address?โ For some moments Aylmore had been growing more and more restive. His brow had flushed; his moustache had begun to twitch. And now he squared his shoulders and faced his questioner defiantly. โI resent these questions about my private affairs!โ he snapped out. โPossibly. But I must put them. I repeat my last question.โ โAnd I refuse to answer it.โ โThen I ask you another. Where did you live in London at the time you are telling us of, when you knew John Marbury?โ โI refuse to answer that question also!โ The Treasury Counsel sat down and looked at the Coroner. Chapter 12 – The New Witness. The voice of the Coroner, bland, suave, deprecating, broke the silence. He was addressing the witness. โI am sure, Mr. Aylmore,โ he said, โthere is no wish to trouble you with unnecessary questions. But we are here to get at the truth of this matter of John Marburyโs death, and as you are the only witness we have had who knew him personallyโโ Aylmore turned impatiently to the Coroner. โI have every wish to respect your authority, sir!โ he exclaimed. โAnd I have told you all that I know of Marbury and of what happened when I met him the other evening. But I resent being questioned on my private affairs of twenty years agoโI very much resent it! Any question that is really pertinent I will answer, but I will not answer questions that seem to me wholly foreign to the scope of this enquiry.โ The Treasury Counsel rose again. His manner had become of the quietest, and Spargo again became keenly attentive. โPerhaps I can put a question or two to Mr. Aylmore which will not yield him offence,โ he remarked drily. He turned once more to the witness, regarding him as if with interest. โCan you tell us of any person now living who knew Marbury in London at the time under discussionโtwenty to twenty-two or three years ago?โ he asked. Aylmore shook his head angrily. โNo, I canโt,โ he replied. โAnd yet you and he must have had several business acquaintances at that time who knew you both!โ โPossiblyโat that time. But when I returned to England my business and my life lay in different directions to those of that time. I donโt know of anybody who knew Marbury thenโanybody.โ The Counsel turned to a clerk who sat behind him, whispered to him; Spargo saw the clerk make a sidelong motion of his head towards the door of the court. The Counsel looked again at the witness. โOne more question. You told the court a little time since that you parted with Marbury on the evening preceding his death at the end of Waterloo Bridgeโat, I think you said, a quarter to twelve.โ โAbout that time.โ โAnd at that place?โ โYes.โ โThat is all I want to ask you, Mr. Aylmoreโjust now,โ said the Counsel. He turned to the Coroner. โI am going to ask you, sir, at this point to call a witness who has volunteered certain evidence to the police authorities this morning. That evidence is of a very important nature, and I think that this is the stage at which it ought to be given to you and the jury. If you would be pleased to direct that David Lyell be calledโโ Spargo turned instinctively to the door, having seen the clerk who had sat behind the Treasury Counsel make his way there. There came into view, ushered by the clerk, a smart-looking, alert, self-confident young man, evidently a Scotsman, who, on the name of David Lyell being called, stepped jauntily and readily into the place which the member of Parliament just vacated. He took the oathโScotch fashionโwith the same readiness and turned easily to the Treasury Counsel. And Spargo, glancing quickly round, saw that the court was breathless with anticipation, and that its anticipation was that the new witness was going to tell something which related to the evidence just given by Aylmore. โYour name is David Lyell?โ โThat is my name, sir.โ โAnd you reside at 23, Cumbrae Side, Kilmarnock, Scotland?โ โI do.โ โWhat are you, Mr. Lyell?โ โTraveller, sir, for the firm of Messrs. Stevenson, Robertson & Soutar, distillers, of Kilmarnock.โ โYour duties take you, I think, over to Paris occasionally?โ โThey doโonce every six weeks I go to Paris.โ โOn the evening of June 21st last were you in London on your way to Paris?โ โI was.โ โI believe you stayed at De Keyserโs Hotel, at the Blackfriars end of the Embankment?โ โI didโitโs handy for the continental trains.โ โAbout half-past eleven, or a little later, that evening, did you go along the Embankment, on the Temple Gardens side, for a walk?โ โI did, sir. Iโm a bad sleeper, and itโs a habit of mine to take a walk of half an hour or so last thing before I go to bed.โ โHow far did you walk?โ โAs far as Waterloo Bridge.โ โAlways on the Temple side?โ โJust so, sirโstraight along on that side.โ โVery good. When you got close to Waterloo Bridge, did you meet anybody you knew?โ โYes.โ โMr. Aylmore, the Member of Parliament.โ Spargo could not avoid a glance at the two sisters. The elderโs head was averted; the younger was staring at the witness steadily. And Breton was nervously tapping his fingers on the crown of his shining silk hat. โMr. Aylmore, the Member of Parliament,โ repeated the Counselโs suave, clear tones. โOh! And how did you come to recognize Mr. Aylmore, Member of Parliament?โ โWell, sir, in this way. At home, Iโm the secretary of our Liberal Ward Club, and last year we had a demonstration, and it fell to me to arrange with the principal speakers. I got Mr. Aylmore to come and speak, and naturally I met him several times, in London and in Scotland.โ โSo that you knew him quite well?โ โOh yes, sir.โ โDo you see him now, Mr. Lyell?โ Lyell smiled and half turned in the box. โWhy, of course!โ he answered. โThere is Mr. Aylmore.โ โThere is Mr. Aylmore. Very good. Now we go on. You met Mr. Aylmore close to Waterloo Bridge? How close?โ โWell, sir, to be exact, Mr. Aylmore came down the steps from the bridge on to the Embankment.โ โAlone?โ โNo.โ โWho was with him?โ โA man, sir.โ โDid you know the man?โ โNo. But seeing who he was with. I took a good look at him. I havenโt forgotten his face.โ โYou havenโt forgotten his face. Mr. Lyellโhas anything recalled that face to you within this last day or two?โ โYes, sir, indeed!โ โWhat?โ โThe picture of the man they say was murderedโJohn Marbury.โ โYouโre sure of that?โ โIโm as certain, sir, as that my nameโs what it is.โ โIt is your belief that Mr. Aylmore, when you met him, was accompanied by the man who, according to the photographs, was John Marbury?โ โIt is, sir!โ โVery well. Now, having seen Mr. Aylmore and his companion, what did you do?โ โOh, I just turned and walked after them.โ โYou walked after them? They were going eastward, then?โ โThey were walking by the way Iโd come.โ โYou followed them eastward?โ โI didโI was going back to the hotel, you see.โ โWhat were they doing?โ โTalking uncommonly earnestly, sir.โ โHow far did you follow them?โ โI followed them until they came to the Embankment lodge of Middle Temple Lane, sir.โ โAnd then?โ โWhy, sir, they turned in there, and I went straight on to De Keyserโs, and to my bed.โ There was a deeper silence in court at that moment than at any other period of the long day, and it grew still deeper when the quiet, keen voice put the next question. โYou swear on your oath that you saw Mr. Aylmore take his companion into the Temple by the Embankment entrance of Middle Temple Lane on the occasion in question?โ โI do! I could swear no other, sir.โ โCan you tell us, as near as possible, what time that would be?โ โYes. It was, to a minute or so, about five minutes past twelve.โ The Treasury Counsel nodded to the Coroner, and the Coroner, after a whispered conference with the foreman of the jury, looked at the witness. โYou have only just given this information to the police, I understand?โ he said. โYes, sir. I have been in Paris, and in Amiens, and I only returned by this morningโs boat. As soon as I had read all the news in the papersโthe English papersโand seen the dead manโs photographs I determined to tell the police what I knew, and I went to New Scotland Yard as soon as I got to London this morning.โ Nobody else wanted to ask Mr. David Lyell any questions, and he stepped down. And Mr. Aylmore suddenly came forward again, seeking the Coronerโs attention. โMay I be allowed to make an explanation, sir?โ he began. โIโโ But the Treasury Counsel was on his feet, this time stern and implacable. โI would point out, sir, that you have had Mr. Aylmore in the box, and that he was not then at all ready to give explanations, or even to answer questions,โ he said. โAnd before you allow him to make any explanation now, I ask you to hear another witness whom I wish to interpose at this stage. That witness isโโโ Mr. Aylmore turned almost angrily to the Coroner. โAfter the evidence of the last witness, I think I have a right to be heard at once!โ he said with emphasis. โAs matters stand at present, it looks as if I had trifled, sir, with you and the jury, whereas if I am allowed to make an explanationโโ โI must respectfully ask that before Mr. Aylmore is allowed to make any explanation, the witness I have referred to is heard,โ said the Treasury Counsel sternly. โThere are weighty reasons.โ โI am afraid you must wait a little, Mr. Aylmore, if you wish to give an explanation,โ said the Coroner. He turned to the Counsel. โWho is this other witness?โ he asked. Aylmore stepped back. And Spargo noticed that the younger of his two daughters was staring at him with an anxious expression. There was no distrust of her father in her face; she was anxious. She, too, slowly turned to the next witness. This man was the porter of the Embankment lodge of Middle Temple Lane. The Treasury Counsel put a straight question to him at once. โYou see that gentleman,โ he said, pointing to Aylmore. โDo you know him as an inmate of the Temple?โ The man stared at Aylmore, evidently confused. โWhy, certainly, sir!โ he answered. โQuite well, sir.โ โVery good. And nowโwhat name do you know him by?โ The man grew evidently more bewildered. โName, sir. Why, Mr. Anderson, sir!โ he replied. โMr. Anderson!โ Chapter 13 – Under Suspicion. A distinct, uncontrollable murmur of surprise ran round the packed court as this man in the witness-box gave this answer. It signified many thingsโthat there were people present who had expected some such dramatic development; that there were others present who had not; that the answer itself was only a prelude to further developments. And Spargo, looking narrowly about him, saw that the answer had aroused different feelings in Aylmoreโs two daughters. The elder one had dropped her face until it was quite hidden; the younger was sitting bolt upright, staring at her father in utter and genuine bewilderment. And for the first time, Aylmore made no response to her. But the course of things was going steadily forward. There was no stopping the Treasury Counsel now; he was going to get at some truth in his own merciless fashion. He had exchanged one glance with the Coroner, had whispered a word to the solicitor who sat close by him, and now he turned again to the witness. โSo you know that gentlemanโmake sure nowโas Mr. Anderson, an inmate of the Temple?โ โYes, sir.โ โYou donโt know him by any other name?โ โNo, sir, I donโt.โ โHow long have you known him by that name?โ โI should say two or three years, sir.โ โSee him go in and out regularly?โ โNo, sirโnot regularly.โ โHow often, then?โ โNow and then, sirโperhaps once a week.โ โTell us what you know of Mr. Andersonโs goings-in-and-out.โ โWell, sir, I might see him two nights running; then I mightnโt see him again for perhaps a week or two. Irregular, as you might say, sir.โ โYou say โnights.โ Do I understand that you never see Mr. Anderson except at night?โ โYes, sir. Iโve never seen him except at night. Always about the same time, sir.โ โWhat time?โ โJust about midnight, sir.โ โVery well. Do you remember the midnight of June 21st-22nd?โ โI do, sir.โ โDid you see Mr. Anderson enter then?โ โYes, sir, just after twelve.โ โWas he alone?โ โNo, sir; there was another gentleman with him.โ โRemember anything about that other gentleman?โ โNothing, sir, except that I noticed as they walked through, that the other gentleman had grey clothes on.โ โHad grey clothes on. You didnโt see his face?โ โNot to remember it, sir. I donโt remember anything but what Iโve told you, sir.โ โThat is that the other gentleman wore a grey suit. Where did Mr. Anderson and this gentleman in the grey suit go when theyโd passed through?โ โStraight up the Lane, sir.โ โDo you know where Mr. Andersonโs rooms in the Temple are?โ โNot exactly, sir, but I understood in Fountain Court.โ โNow, on that night in question, did Mr. Anderson leave again by your lodge?โ โNo, sir.โ โYou heard of the discovery of the body of a dead man in Middle Temple Lane next morning?โ โI did, sir.โ โDid you connect that man with the gentleman in the grey suit?โ โNo, sir, I didnโt. It never occurred to me. A lot of the gentlemen who live in the Temple bring friends in late of nights; I never gave the matter any particular thought.โ โNever mentioned it to anybody until now, when you were sent for to come here?โ โNo, sir, never, to anybody.โ โAnd you have never known the gentleman standing there as anybody but Mr. Anderson?โ โNo, sir, never heard any other name but Anderson.โ The Coroner glanced at the Counsel. โI think this may be a convenient opportunity for Mr. Aylmore to give the explanation he offered a few minutes ago,โ he said. โDo you suggest anything?โ โI suggest, sir, that if Mr. Aylmore desires to give any explanation he should return to the witness-box and submit himself to examination again on his oath,โ replied the Counsel. โThe matter is in your hands.โ The Coroner turned to Aylmore. โDo you object to that?โ he asked. Aylmore stepped boldly forward and into the box. โI object to nothing,โ he said in clear tones, โexcept to being asked to reply to questions about matters of the past which have not and cannot have anything to do with this case. Ask me what questions you like, arising out of the evidence of the last two witnesses, and I will answer them so far as I see myself justified in doing so. Ask me questions about matters of twenty years ago, and I shall answer them or not as I see fit. And I may as well say that I will take all the consequences of my silence or my speech.โ The Treasury Counsel rose again. โVery well, Mr. Aylmore,โ he said. โI will put certain questions to you. You heard the evidence of David Lyell?โ โI did.โ โWas that quite true as regards yourself?โ โQuite trueโabsolutely true.โ โAnd you heard that of the last witness. Was that also true!โ โEqually true.โ โThen you admit that the evidence you gave this morning, before these witnesses came on the scene, was not true?โ โNo, I do not! Most emphatically I do not. It was true.โ โTrue? You told me, on oath, that you parted from John Marbury on Waterloo Bridge!โ โPardon me, I said nothing of the sort. I said that from the Anglo-Orient Hotel we strolled across Waterloo Bridge, and that shortly afterwards we partedโI did not say where we parted. I see there is a shorthand writer here who is taking everything downโask him if that is not exactly what I said?โ A reference to the stenographer proved Aylmore to be right, and the Treasury Counsel showed plain annoyance. โWell, at any rate, you so phrased your answer that nine persons out of ten would have understood that you parted from Marbury in the open streets after crossing Waterloo Bridge,โ he said. โNowโ?โ Aylmore smiled. โI am not responsible for the understanding of nine people out of ten any more than I am for your understanding,โ he said, with a sneer. โI said what I now repeatโMarbury and I walked across Waterloo Bridge, and shortly afterwards we parted. I told you the truth.โ โIndeed! Perhaps you will continue to tell us the truth. Since you have admitted that the evidence of the last two witnesses is absolutely correct, perhaps you will tell us exactly where you and Marbury did part?โ โI willโwillingly. We parted at the door of my chambers in Fountain Court.โ โThenโto reiterateโit was you who took Marbury into the Temple that night?โ โIt was certainly I who took Marbury into the Temple that night.โ There was another murmur amongst the crowded benches. Here at any rate was factโsolid, substantial fact. And Spargo began to see a possible course of events which he had not anticipated. โThat is a candid admission, Mr. Aylmore. I suppose you see a certain danger to yourself in making it.โ โI need not say whether I do or I do not. I have made it.โ โVery good. Why did you not make it before?โ โFor my own reasons. I told you as much as I considered necessary for the purpose of this enquiry. I have virtually altered nothing now. I asked to be allowed to make a statement, to give an explanation, as soon as Mr. Lyell had left this box: I was not allowed to do so. I am willing to make it now.โ โMake it then.โ โIt is simply this,โ said Aylmore, turning to the Coroner. โI have found it convenient, during the past three years, to rent a simple set of chambers in the Temple, where I could occasionallyโvery occasionally, as a ruleโgo late at night. I also found it convenient, for my own reasonsโwith which, I think, no one has anything to doโto rent those chambers under the name of Mr. Anderson. It was to my chambers that Marbury accompanied me for a few moments on the midnight with which we are dealing. He was not in them more than five minutes at the very outside: I parted from him at my outer door, and I understood that he would leave the Temple by the way we had entered and would drive or walk straight back to his hotel. That is the whole truth. I wish to add that I ought perhaps to have told all this at first. I had reasons for not doing so. I told what I considered necessary, that I parted from Marbury, leaving him well and alive, soon after midnight.โ โWhat reasons were or are they which prevented you from telling all this at first?โ asked the Treasury Counsel. โReasons which are private to me.โ โWill you tell them to the court?โ โNo!โ โThen will you tell us why Marbury went with you to the chambers in Fountain Court which you tenant under the name of Anderson?โ โYes. To fetch a document which I had in my keeping, and had kept for him for twenty years or more.โ โA document of importance?โ โOf very great importance. โHe would have it on him when he wasโas we believe he wasโmurdered and robbed?โ โHe had it on him when he left me.โ โWill you tell us what it was?โ โCertainly not!โ โIn fact, you wonโt tell us any more than you choose to tell?โ โI have told you all I can tell of the events of that night.โ โThen I am going to ask you a very pertinent question. Is it not a fact that you know a great deal more about John Marbury than you have told this court?โ โThat I shall not answer.โ โIs it not a fact that you could, if you would, tell this court more about John Marbury and your acquaintanceship with him twenty years ago?โ โI also decline to answer that.โ The Treasury Counsel made a little movement of his shoulders and turned to the Coroner. โI should suggest, sir, that you adjourn this enquiry,โ he said quietly. โFor a week,โ assented the Coroner, turning to the jury. The crowd surged out of the court, chattering, murmuring, exclaimingโ spectators, witnesses, jurymen, reporters, legal folk, police folk, all mixed up together. And Spargo, elbowing his own way out, and busily reckoning up the value of the new complexions put on everything by the dayโs work, suddenly felt a hand laid on his arm. Turning he found himself gazing at Jessie Aylmore. Chapter 14 – The Silver Ticket. With a sudden instinct of protection, Spargo quickly drew the girl aside from the struggling crowd, and within a moment had led her into a quiet by-street. He looked down at her as she stood recovering her breath. โYes?โ he said quietly. Jessie Aylmore looked up at him, smiling faintly. โI want to speak to you,โ she said. โI must speak to you.โ โYes,โ said Spargo. โButโthe others? Your sister?โBreton?โ โI left them on purpose to speak to you,โ she answered. โThey knew I did. I am well accustomed to looking after myself.โ Spargo moved down the by-street, motioning his companion to move with him. โTea,โ he said, โis what you want. I know a queer, old-fashioned place close by here where you can get the best China tea in London. Come and have some.โ Jessie Aylmore smiled and followed her guide obediently. And Spargo said nothing, marching stolidly along with his thumbs in his waistcoat pockets, his fingers playing soundless tunes outside, until he had installed himself and his companion in a quiet nook in the old tea-house he had told her of, and had given an order for tea and hot tea-cakes to a waitress who evidently knew him. Then he turned to her. โYou want,โ he said, โto talk to me about your father.โ โYes,โ she answered. โI do.โ โWhy?โ asked Spargo. The girl gave him a searching look. โRonald Breton says youโre the man whoโs written all those special articles in the _Watchman_ about the Marbury case,โ she answered. โAre you?โ โI am,โ said Spargo. โThen youโre a man of great influence,โ she went on. โYou can stir the public mind. Mr. Spargoโwhat are you going to write about my father and todayโs proceedings?โ Spargo signed to her to pour out the tea which had just arrived. He seized, without ceremony, upon a piece of the hot buttered tea-cake, and bit a great lump out of it. โFrankly,โ he mumbled, speaking with his mouth full, โfrankly, I donโt know. I donโt knowโyet. But Iโll tell you thisโitโs best to be candidโI shouldnโt allow myself to be prejudiced or biassed in making up my conclusions by anything that you may say to me. Understand?โ Jessie Aylmore took a sudden liking to Spargo because of the unconventionality and brusqueness of his manners. โIโm not wanting to prejudice or bias you,โ she said. โAll I want is that you should be very sure before you sayโanything.โ โIโll be sure,โ said Spargo. โDonโt bother. Is the tea all right?โ โBeautiful!โ she answered, with a smile that made Spargo look at her again. โDelightful! Mr. Spargo, tell me!โwhat did you think aboutโabout what has just happened?โ Spargo, regardless of the fact that his fingers were liberally ornamented with butter, lifted a hand and rubbed his always untidy hair. Then he ate more tea-cake and gulped more tea. โLook here!โ he said suddenly. โIโm no great hand at talking. I can write pretty decently when Iโve a good story to tell, but I donโt talk an awful lot, because I never can express what I mean unless Iโve got a pen in my hand. Frankly, I find it hard to tell you what I think. When I write my article this evening, Iโll get all these things marshalled in proper form, and I shall write clearly about ’em. But Iโll tell you one thing I do thinkโI wish your father had made a clean breast of things to me at first, when he gave me that interview, or had told everything when he first went into that box.โ โWhy?โ she asked. โBecause heโs now set up an atmosphere of doubt and suspicion around himself. Peopleโll thinkโHeaven knows what theyโll think! They already know that he knows more about Marbury than heโll tell, thatโโ โBut does he?โ she interrupted quickly. โDo you think he does?โ โYes!โ replied Spargo, with emphasis. โI do. A lot more! If he had only been explicit at firstโhowever, he wasnโt. Now itโs done. As things standโlook here, does it strike you that your father is in a very serious position?โ โSerious?โ she exclaimed. โDangerous! Hereโs the factโheโs admitted that he took Marbury to his rooms in the Temple that midnight. Well, next morning Marburyโs found robbed and murdered in an entry, not fifty yards off!โ โDoes anybody suppose that my father would murder him for the sake of robbing him of whatever he had on him?โ she laughed scornfully. โMy father is a very wealthy man, Mr. Spargo.โ โMay be,โ answered Spargo. โBut millionaires have been known to murder men who held secrets.โ โSecrets!โ she exclaimed. โHave some more tea,โ said Spargo, nodding at the teapot. โLook hereโthis way it is. The theory that peopleโsome peopleโwill build up (I wonโt say that it hasnโt suggested itself to me) is this:โThereโs some mystery about the relationship, acquaintanceship, connection, call it what you like, of your father and Marbury twenty odd years ago. Must be. Thereโs some mystery about your fatherโs life, twenty odd years ago. Must beโor else heโd have answered those questions. Very well. โHa, ha!โ says the general public. โNow we have it!โ โMarbury,โ says the general public, โwas a man who had a hold on Aylmore. He turned up. Aylmore trapped him into the Temple, killed him to preserve his own secret, and robbed him of all he had on him as a blind.โ Eh?โ โYou thinkโpeople will say that?โ she exclaimed. โCock-sure! Theyโre saying it. Heard half a dozen of ’em say it, in more or less elegant fashion as I came out of that court. Of course, theyโll say it. Why, what else could they say?โ For a moment Jessie Aylmore sat looking silently into her tea-cup. Then she turned her eyes on Spargo, who immediately manifested a new interest in what remained of the tea-cakes. โIs that what youโre going to say in your article tonight?โ she asked, quietly. โNo!โ replied Spargo, promptly. โIt isnโt. Iโm going to sit on the fence tonight. Besides, the case is _sub judice_. All Iโm going to do is to tell, in my way, what took place at the inquest.โ The girl impulsively put her hand across the table and laid it on Spargoโs big fist. โIs it what you think?โ she asked in a low voice. โHonour bright, no!โ exclaimed Spargo. โIt isnโtโit isnโt! I donโt think it. I think thereโs a most extraordinary mystery at the bottom of Marburyโs death, and I think your father knows an enormous lot about Marbury that he wonโt tell, but Iโm certain sure that he neither killed Marbury nor knows anything whatever about his death. And as Iโm out to clear this mystery up, and mean to do it, nothingโll make me more glad than to clear your father. I say, do have some more tea-cake? Weโll have fresh onesโand fresh tea.โ โNo, thank you,โ she said smiling. โAnd thank you for what youโve just said. Iโm going now, Mr. Spargo. Youโve done me good.โ โOh, rot!โ exclaimed Spargo. โNothingโnothing! Iโve just told you what Iโm thinking. You must go?โฆโ He saw her into a taxi-cab presently, and when she had gone stood vacantly staring after the cab until a hand clapped him smartly on the shoulder. Turning, he found Rathbury grinning at him. โAll right, Mr. Spargo, I saw you!โ he said. โWell, itโs a pleasant change to squire young ladies after being all day in that court. Look here, are you going to start your writing just now?โ โIโm not going to start my writing as you call it, until after Iโve dined at seven oโclock and given myself time to digest my modest dinner,โ answered Spargo. โWhat is it?โ โCome back with me and have another look at that blessed leather box,โ said Rathbury. โIโve got it in my room, and Iโd like to examine it for myself. Come on!โ โThe thingโs empty,โ said Spargo. โThere might be a false bottom in it,โ remarked Rathbury. โOne never knows. Here, jump into this!โ He pushed Spargo into a passing taxi-cab, and following, bade the driver go straight to the Yard. Arrived there, he locked Spargo and himself into the drab-visaged room in which the journalist had seen him before. โWhat dโye think of todayโs doings, Spargo?โ he asked, as he proceeded to unlock a cupboard. โI think,โ said Spargo, โthat some of you fellows must have had your ears set to tingling.โ โThatโs so,โ assented Rathbury. โOf course, the next thingโll be to find out all about the Mr. Aylmore of twenty years since. When a man wonโt tell you where he lived twenty years ago, what he was exactly doing, what his precise relationship with another man wasโwhy, then, youโve just got to find out, eh? Oh, some of our fellows are at work on the life history of Stephen Aylmore, Esq., M.P., alreadyโyou bet! Well, now, Spargo, hereโs the famous box.โ The detective brought the old leather case out of the cupboard in which he had been searching, and placed it on his desk. Spargo threw back the lid and looked inside, measuring the inner capacity against the exterior lines. โNo false bottom in that, Rathbury,โ he said. โThereโs just the outer leather case, and the inner lining, of this old bed-hanging stuff, and thatโs all. Thereโs no room for any false bottom or anything of that sort, dโyou see?โ Rathbury also sized up the boxโs capacity. โLooks like it,โ he said disappointedly. โWell, what about the lid, then? I remember there was an old box like this in my grandmotherโs farmhouse, where I was rearedโthere was a pocket in the lid. Letโs see if thereโs anything of the sort here?โ He threw the lid back and began to poke about the lining of it with the tips of his fingers, and presently he turned to his companion with a sharp exclamation. โBy George, Spargo!โ he said. โI donโt know about any pocket, but thereโs something under this lining. Feels likeโhere, you feel. Thereโand there.โ Spargo put a finger on the places indicated. โYes, thatโs so,โ he agreed. โFeels like two cardsโa large and a small one. And the small oneโs harder than the other. Better cut that lining out, Rathbury.โ โThat,โ remarked Rathbury, producing a pen-knife, โis just what Iโm going to do. Weโll cut along this seam.โ He ripped the lining carefully open along the upper part of the lining of the lid, and looking into the pocket thus made, drew out two objects which he dropped on his blotting pad. โA childโs photograph,โ he said, glancing at one of them. โBut what on earth is that?โ The object to which he pointed was a small, oblong piece of thin, much-worn silver, about the size of a railway ticket. On one side of it was what seemed to be a heraldic device or coat-of-arms, almost obliterated by rubbing; on the other, similarly worn down by friction, was the figure of a horse. โThatโs a curious object,โ remarked Spargo, picking it up. โI never saw anything like that before. What can it be?โ โDonโt knowโI never saw anything of the sort either,โ said Rathbury. โSome old token, I should say. Now this photo. Ahโyou see, the photographerโs name and address have been torn away or broken offโthereโs nothing left but just two letters of whatโs apparently been the name of the townโsee. Erโthatโs all there is. Portrait of a baby, eh?โ Spargo gave, what might have been called in anybody else but him, a casual glance at the babyโs portrait. He picked up the silver ticket again and turned it over and over. โLook here, Rathbury,โ he said. โLet me take this silver thing. I know where I can find out what it is. At least, I think I do.โ โAll right,โ agreed the detective, โbut take the greatest care of it, and donโt tell a soul that we found it in this box, you know. No connection with the Marbury case, Spargo, remember.โ โOh, all right,โ said Spargo. โTrust me. โ He put the silver ticket in his pocket, and went back to the office, wondering about this singular find. And when he had written his article that evening, and seen a proof of it, Spargo went into Fleet Street intent on seeking peculiar information. Chapter 15 – Market Milcaster. The haunt of well-informed men which Spargo had in view when he turned out of the _Watchman_ office lay well hidden from ordinary sight and knowledge in one of those Fleet Street courts the like of which is not elsewhere in the world. Only certain folk knew of it. It was, of course, a club; otherwise it would not have been what it was. It is the simplest thing in life, in England, at any rate, to form a club of congenial spirits. You get so many of your choice friends and acquaintances to gather round you; you register yourselves under a name of your own choosing; you take a house and furnish it according to your means and your taste: you comply with the very easy letter of the law, and there you are. Keep within that easy letter, and you can do what you please on your own premises. It is much more agreeable to have a small paradise of your own of this description than to lounge about Fleet Street bars. The particular club to which Spargo bent his steps was called the Octoneumenoi. Who evolved this extraordinary combination of Latin and Greek was a dark mystery: there it was, however, on a tiny brass plate you once reached the portals. The portals were gained by devious ways. You turned out of Fleet Street by an alley so narrow that it seemed as if you might suddenly find yourself squeezed between the ancient walls. Then you suddenly dived down another alley and found yourself in a small court, with high walls around you and a smell of printerโs ink in your nose and a whirring of printing presses in your ears. You made another dive into a dark entry, much encumbered by bales of paper, crates of printing material, jars of printing ink; after falling over a few of these you struck an ancient flight of stairs and went up past various landings, always travelling in a state of gloom and fear. After a lot of twisting and turning you came to the very top of the house and found it heavily curtained off. You lifted a curtain and found yourself in a small entresol, somewhat artistically paintedโthe whole and sole work of an artistic member who came one day with a formidable array of lumber and paint-pots and worked his will on the ancient wood. Then you saw the brass plate and its fearful name, and beneath it the formal legal notice that this club was duly registered and so on, and if you were a member you went in, and if you werenโt a member you tinkled an electric bell and asked to see a memberโif you knew one. Spargo was not a member, but he knew many members, and he tinkled the bell, and asked the boy who answered it for Mr. Starkey. Mr. Starkey, a young gentleman with the biceps of a prize-fighter and a head of curly hair that would have done credit to Antinous, came forth in due course and shook Spargo by the hand until his teeth rattled. โHad we known you were coming,โ said Mr. Starkey, โweโd have had a brass band on the stairs.โ โI want to come in,โ remarked Spargo. โSure!โ said Mr. Starkey. โThatโs what youโve come for.โ โWell, stand out of the way, then, and letโs get in,โ said Spargo. โLook here,โ he continued when they had penetrated into a small vestibule, โdoesnโt old Crowfoot turn in here about this time every night?โ โEvery night as true as the clock, my son Spargo, Crowfoot puts his nose in at precisely eleven, having by that time finished that daily column wherein he informs a section of the populace as to the prospects of their spotting a winner tomorrow,โ answered Mr. Starkey. โItโs five minutes to his hour now. Come in and drink till he comes. Want him?โ โA word with him,โ answered Spargo. โA mere wordโor two.โ He followed Starkey into a room which was so filled with smoke and sound that for a moment it was impossible to either see or hear. But the smoke was gradually making itself into a canopy, and beneath the canopy Spargo made out various groups of men of all ages, sitting around small tables, smoking and drinking, and all talking as if the great object of their lives was to get as many words as possible out of their mouths in the shortest possible time. In the further corner was a small bar; Starkey pulled Spargo up to it. โName it, my son,โ commanded Starkey. โTry the Octoneumenoi very extra special. Two of ’em, Dick. Come to beg to be a member, Spargo?โ โIโll think about being a member of this ante-room of the infernal regions when you start a ventilating fan and provide members with a route-map of the way from Fleet Street,โ answered Spargo, taking his glass. โPhew!โwhat an atmosphere!โ โWeโre considering a ventilating fan,โ said Starkey. โIโm on the house committee now, and I brought that very matter up at our last meeting. But Templeson, of the _Bulletin_โyou know Templesonโhe says what we want is a wine-cooler to stand under that sideboardโsays no club is proper without a wine-cooler, and that he knows a chapโsecond-hand dealer, donโt you knowโwhat has a beauty to dispose of in old Sheffield plate. Now, if you were on our house committee, Spargo, old man, would you go in for the wine-cooler or the ventilating fan? You seeโโ โThere is Crowfoot,โ said Spargo. โShout him over here, Starkey, before anybody else collars him.โ Through the door by which Spargo had entered a few minutes previously came a man who stood for a moment blinking at the smoke and the lights. He was a tall, elderly man with a figure and bearing of a soldier; a big, sweeping moustache stood well out against a square-cut jaw and beneath a prominent nose; a pair of keen blue eyes looked out from beneath a tousled mass of crinkled hair. He wore neither hat nor cap; his attire was a carelessly put on Norfolk suit of brown tweed; he looked half-unkempt, half-groomed. But knotted at the collar of his flannel shirt were the colours of one of the most famous and exclusive cricket clubs in the world, and everybody knew that in his day their wearer had been a mighty figure in the public eye. โHi, Crowfoot!โ shouted Starkey above the din and babel. โCrowfoot, Crowfoot! Come over here, thereโs a chap dying to see you!โ โYes, thatโs the way to get him, isnโt it?โ said Spargo. โHere, Iโll get him myself.โ He went across the room and accosted the old sporting journalist. โI want a quiet word with you,โ he said. โThis place is like a pandemonium.โ Crowfoot led the way into a side alcove and ordered a drink. โAlways is, this time,โ he said, yawning. โBut itโs companionable. What is it, Spargo?โ Spargo took a pull at the glass which he had carried with him. โI should say,โ he said, โthat you know as much about sporting matters as any man writing about ’em?โ โWell, I think you might say it with truth,โ answered Crowfoot. โAnd old sporting matters?โ said Spargo. โYes, and old sporting matters,โ replied the other with a sudden flash of the eye. โNot that they greatly interest the modern generation, you know.โ โWell, thereโs something thatโs interesting me greatly just now, anyway,โ said Spargo. โAnd I believe itโs got to do with old sporting affairs. And I came to you for information about it, believing you to be the only man I know of that could tell anything.โ โYesโwhat is it?โ asked Crowfoot. Spargo drew out an envelope, and took from it the carefully-wrapped-up silver ticket. He took off the wrappings and laid the ticket on Crowfootโs outstretched palm. โCan you tell me what that is?โ he asked. Another sudden flash came into the old sportsmanโs eyesโhe eagerly turned the silver ticket over. โGod bless my soul!โ he exclaimed. โWhere did you get this?โ โNever mind, just now,โ replied Spargo. โYou know what it is?โ โCertainly I know what it is! ButโGad! Iโve not seen one of these things for Lord knows how many years. It makes me feel something like a young โun again!โ said Crowfoot. โQuite a young โun!โ โBut what is it?โ asked Spargo. Crowfoot turned the ticket over, showing the side on which the heraldic device was almost worn away. โItโs one of the original silver stand tickets of the old racecourse at Market Milcaster,โ answered Crowfoot. โThatโs what it is. One of the old original silver stand tickets. There are the arms of Market Milcaster, you see, nearly worn away by much rubbing. There, on the obverse, is the figure of a running horse. Oh, yes, thatโs what it is! Bless me!โmost interesting.โ โWhereโs Market Milcaster?โ enquired Spargo. โDonโt know it.โ โMarket Milcaster,โ replied Crowfoot, still turning the silver ticket over and over, โis what the topographers call a decayed town in Elmshire. It has steadily decayed since the river that led to it got gradually silted up. There used to be a famous race-meeting there in June every year. Itโs nearly forty years since that meeting fell through. I went to it often when I was a ladโoften!โ โAnd you say thatโs a ticket for the stand?โ asked Spargo. โThis is one of fifty silver tickets, or passes, or whatever you like to call ’em, which were given by the race committee to fifty burgesses of the town,โ answered Crowfoot. โIt was, I remember, considered a great privilege to possess a silver ticket. It admitted its possessorโfor life, mind you!โto the stand, the paddocks, the ring, anywhere. It also gave him a place at the annual race-dinner. Where on earth did you get this, Spargo?โ Spargo took the ticket and carefully re-wrapped it, this time putting it in his purse. โIโm awfully obliged to you, Crowfoot,โ he said, โThe fact is, I canโt tell you where I got it just now, but Iโll promise you that I will tell you, and all about it, too, as soon as my tongueโs free to do so.โ โSome mystery, eh?โ suggested Crowfoot. โConsiderable,โ answered Spargo. โDonโt mention to anyone that I showed it to you. You shall know everything eventually.โ โOh, all right, my boy, all right!โ said Crowfoot. โOdd how things turn up, isnโt it? Now, Iโll wager anything that there arenโt half a dozen of these old things outside Market Milcaster itself. As I said, there were only fifty, and they were all in possession of burgesses. They were so much thought of that they were taken great care of. Iโve been in Market Milcaster myself since the races were given up, and Iโve seen these tickets carefully framed and hung over mantelpiecesโoh, yes!โ Spargo caught at a notion. โHow do you get to Market Milcaster?โ he asked. โPaddington,โ replied Crowfoot. โItโs a goodish way.โ โI wonder,โ said Spargo, โif thereโs any old sporting man there who could rememberโthings. Anything about this ticket, for instance?โ โOld sporting man!โ exclaimed Crowfoot. โEgad!โbut no, he must be deadโanyhow, if he isnโt dead, he must be a veritable patriarch. Old Ben Quarterpage, he was an auctioneer in the town, and a rare sportsman.โ โI may go down there,โ said Spargo. โIโll see if heโs alive.โ โThen, if you do go down,โ suggested Crowfoot, โgo to the old โYellow Dragonโ in the High Street, a fine old place. Quarterpageโs place of business and his private house were exactly opposite the โDragon.โ But Iโm afraid youโll find him deadโitโs five and twenty years since I was in Market Milcaster, and he was an old bird then. Letโs see, now. If Old Ben Quarterpage is alive, Spargo, heโll be ninety years of age!โ โWell, Iโve known men of ninety who were spry enough, even in my bit of experience,โ said Spargo. โI know oneโnowโmy own grandfather. Well, the best of thanks, Crowfoot, and Iโll tell you all about it some day.โ โHave another drink?โ suggested Crowfoot. But Spargo excused himself. He was going back to the office, he said; he still had something to do. And he got himself away from the Octoneumenoi, in spite of Starkey, who wished to start a general debate on the wisest way of expending the clubโs ready money balance, and went back to the _Watchman_, and there he sought the presence of the editor, and in spite of the fact that it was the busiest hour of the night, saw him and remained closeted with him for the extraordinary space of ten minutes. And after that Spargo went home and fell into bed. But next morning, bright and early, he was on the departure platform at Paddington, suit-case in hand, and ticket in pocket for Market Milcaster, and in the course of that afternoon he found himself in an old-fashioned bedroom looking out on Market Milcaster High Street. And there, right opposite him, he saw an ancient house, old brick, ivy-covered, with an office at its side, over the door of which was the name, _Benjamin Quarterpage_. Chapter 16 – The ‘Yellow Dragon’. Spargo, changing his clothes, washing away the dust of his journey, in that old-fashioned lavender-scented bedroom, busied his mind in further speculations on his plan of campaign in Market Milcaster. He had no particularly clear plan. The one thing he was certain of was that in the old leather box which the man whom he knew as John Marbury had deposited with the London and Universal Safe Deposit Company, he and Rathbury had discovered one of the old silver tickets of Market Milcaster racecourse, and that he, Spargo, had come to Market Milcaster, with the full approval of his editor, in an endeavour to trace it. How was he going to set about this difficult task? โThe first thing,โ said Spargo to himself as he tied a new tie, โis to have a look round. Thatโll be no long job.โ For he had already seen as he approached the town, and as he drove from the station to the โYellow Dragonโ Hotel, that Market Milcaster was a very small place. It chiefly consisted of one long, wide thoroughfareโthe High Streetโwith smaller streets leading from it on either side. In the High Street seemed to be everything that the town could showโthe ancient parish church, the town hall, the market cross, the principal houses and shops, the bridge, beneath which ran the river whereon ships had once come up to the town before its mouth, four miles away, became impassably silted up. It was a bright, clean, little town, but there were few signs of trade in it, and Spargo had been quick to notice that in the โYellow Dragon,โ a big, rambling old hostelry, reminiscent of the old coaching days, there seemed to be little doing. He had eaten a bit of lunch in the coffee-room immediately on his arrival; the coffee-room was big enough to accommodate a hundred and fifty people, but beyond himself, an old gentleman and his daughter, evidently tourists, two young men talking golf, a man who looked like an artist, and an unmistakable honeymooning couple, there was no one in it. There was little traffic in the wide street beneath Spargoโs windows; little passage of people to and fro on the sidewalks; here a countryman drove a lazy cow as lazily along; there a farmer in his light cart sat idly chatting with an aproned tradesman, who had come out of his shop to talk to him. Over everything lay the quiet of the sunlight of the summer afternoon, and through the open windows stole a faint, sweet scent of the new-mown hay lying in the meadows outside the old houses. โA veritable Sleepy Hollow,โ mused Spargo. โLetโs go down and see if thereโs anybody to talk to. Great Scott!โto think that I was in the poisonous atmosphere of the Octoneumenoi only sixteen hours ago!โ Spargo, after losing himself in various corridors and passages, finally landed in the wide, stone-paved hall of the old hotel, and with a sure instinct turned into the bar-parlour which he had noticed when he entered the place. This was a roomy, comfortable, bow-windowed apartment, looking out upon the High Street, and was furnished and ornamented with the usual appurtenances of country-town hotels. There were old chairs and tables and sideboards and cupboards, which had certainly been made a century before, and seemed likely to endure for a century or two longer; there were old prints of the road and the chase, and an old oil-painting or two of red-faced gentlemen in pink coats; there were foxesโ masks on the wall, and a monster pike in a glass case on a side-table; there were ancient candlesticks on the mantelpiece and an antique snuff-box set between them. Also there was a small, old-fashioned bar in a corner of the room, and a new-fashioned young woman seated behind it, who was yawning over a piece of fancy needlework, and looked at Spargo when he entered as Andromeda may have looked at Perseus when he made arrival at her rock. And Spargo, treating himself to a suitable drink and choosing a cigar to accompany it, noted the look, and dropped into the nearest chair. โThis,โ he remarked, eyeing the damsel with enquiry, โappears to me to be a very quiet place.โ โQuiet!โ exclaimed the lady. โQuiet?โ โThat,โ continued Spargo, โis precisely what I observed. Quiet. I see that you agree with me. You expressed your agreement with two shades of emphasis, the surprised and the scornful. We may conclude, thus far, that the place is undoubtedly quiet.โ The damsel looked at Spargo as if she considered him in the light of a new specimen, and picking up her needlework she quitted the bar and coming out into the room took a chair near his own. โIt makes you thankful to see a funeral go by here,โ she remarked. โItโs about all that one ever does see.โ โAre there many?โ asked Spargo. โDo the inhabitants die much of inanition?โ The damsel gave Spargo another critical inspection. โOh, youโre joking!โ she said. โItโs well you can. Nothing ever happens here. This place is a back number.โ โEven the back numbers make pleasant reading at times,โ murmured Spargo. โAnd the backwaters of life are refreshing. Nothing doing in this town, then?โ he added in a louder voice. โNothing!โ replied his companion. โItโs fast asleep. I came here from Birmingham, and I didnโt know what I was coming to. In Birmingham you see as many people in ten minutes as you see here in ten months.โ โAh!โ said Spargo. โWhat you are suffering from is dulness. You must have an antidote.โ โDulness!โ exclaimed the damsel. โThatโs the right word for Market Milcaster. Thereโs just a few regular old customers drop in here of a morning, between eleven and one. A stray caller looks inโperhaps during the afternoon. Then, at night, a lot of old fogies sit round that end of the room and talk about old times. Old times, indeed!โwhat they want in Market Milcaster is new times.โ Spargo pricked up his ears. โWell, but itโs rather interesting to hear old fogies talk about old times,โ he said. โI love it!โ โThen you can get as much of it as ever you want here,โ remarked the barmaid. โLook in tonight any time after eight oโclock, and if you donโt know more about the history of Market Milcaster by ten than you did when you sat down, you must be deaf. There are some old gentlemen drop in here every night, regular as clockwork, who seem to feel that they couldnโt go to bed unless theyโve told each other stories about old days which I should think theyโve heard a thousand times already!โ โVery old men?โ asked Spargo. โMethuselahs,โ replied the lady. โThereโs old Mr. Quarterpage, across the way there, the auctioneer, though he doesnโt do any business nowโthey say heโs ninety, though Iโm sure you wouldnโt take him for more than seventy. And thereโs Mr. Lummis, further down the streetโheโs eighty-one. And Mr. Skene, and Mr. Kayeโtheyโre regular patriarchs. Iโve sat here and listened to them till I believe I could write a history of Market Milcaster since the year One.โ โI can conceive of that as a pleasant and profitable occupation,โ said Spargo. He chatted a while longer in a fashion calculated to cheer the barmaidโs spirits, after which he went out and strolled around the town until seven oโclock, the โDragonโsโ hour for dinner. There were no more people in the big coffee-room than there had been at lunch and Spargo was glad, when his solitary meal was over, to escape to the bar-parlour, where he took his coffee in a corner near to that sacred part in which the old townsmen had been reported to him to sit. โAnd mind you donโt sit in one of their chairs,โ said the barmaid, warningly. โThey all have their own special chairs and their special pipes there on that rack, and I suppose the ceiling would fall in if anybody touched pipe or chair. But youโre all right there, and youโll hear all theyโve got to say.โ To Spargo, who had never seen anything of the sort before, and who, twenty-four hours previously, would have believed the thing impossible, the proceedings of that evening in the bar-parlour of the โYellow Dragonโ at Market Milcaster were like a sudden transference to the eighteenth century. Precisely as the clock struck eight and a bell began to toll somewhere in the recesses of the High Street, an old gentleman walked in, and the barmaid, catching Spargoโs eye, gave him a glance which showed that the play was about to begin. โGood evening, Mr. Kaye,โ said the barmaid. โYouโre first tonight.โ โEvening,โ said Mr. Kaye and took a seat, scowled around him, and became silent. He was a tall, lank old gentleman, clad in rusty black clothes, with a pointed collar sticking up on both sides of his fringe of grey whisker and a voluminous black neckcloth folded several times round his neck, and by the expression of his countenance was inclined to look on life severely. โNobody been in yet?โ asked Mr. Kaye. โNo, but hereโs Mr. Lummis and Mr. Skene,โ replied the barmaid. Two more old gentlemen entered the bar-parlour. Of these, one was a little, dapper-figured man, clad in clothes of an eminently sporting cut, and of very loud pattern; he sported a bright blue necktie, a flower in his lapel, and a tall white hat, which he wore at a rakish angle. The other was a big, portly, bearded man with a Falstaffian swagger and a rakish eye, who chaffed the barmaid as he entered, and gave her a good-humoured chuck under the chin as he passed her. These two also sank into chairs which seemed to have been specially designed to meet them, and the stout man slapped the arms of his as familiarly as he had greeted the barmaid. He looked at his two cronies. โWell?โ he said, โHereโs three of us. And thereโs a symposium.โ โWait a bit, wait a bit,โ said the dapper little man. โGrandpaโll be here in a minute. Weโll start fair.โ The barmaid glanced out of the window. โThereโs Mr. Quarterpage coming across the street now,โ she announced. โShall I put the things on the table?โ โAye, put them on, my dear, put them on!โ commanded the fat man. โHave all in readiness. โ The barmaid thereupon placed a round table before the sacred chairs, set out upon it a fine old punch-bowl and the various ingredients for making punch, a box of cigars, and an old leaden tobacco-box, and she had just completed this interesting prelude to the eveningโs discourse when the door opened again and in walked one of the most remarkable old men Spargo had ever seen. And by this time, knowing that this was the venerable Mr. Benjamin Quarterpage, of whom Crowfoot had told him, he took good stock of the newcomer as he took his place amongst his friends, who on their part received him with ebullitions of delight which were positively boyish. Mr. Quarterpage was a youthful buck of ninetyโa middle-sized, sturdily-built man, straight as a dart, still active of limb, clear-eyed, and strong of voice. His clean-shaven old countenance was ruddy as a sun-warmed pippin; his hair was still only silvered; his hand was steady as a rock. His clothes of buff-coloured whipcord were smart and jaunty, his neckerchief as gay as if he had been going to a fair. It seemed to Spargo that Mr. Quarterpage had a pretty long lease of life before him even at his age. Spargo, in his corner, sat fascinated while the old gentlemen began their symposium. Another, making five, came in and joined themโthe five had the end of the bar-parlour to themselves. Mr. Quarterpage made the punch with all due solemnity and ceremony; when it was ladled out each man lighted his pipe or took a cigar, and the tongues began to wag. Other folk came and went; the old gentlemen were oblivious of anything but their own talk. Now and then a young gentleman of the town dropped in to take his modest half-pint of bitter beer and to dally in the presence of the barmaid; such looked with awe at the patriarchs: as for the patriarchs themselves they were lost in the past. Spargo began to understand what the damsel behind the bar meant when she said that she believed she could write a history of Market Milcaster since the year One. After discussing the weather, the local events of the day, and various personal matters, the old fellows got to reminiscences of the past, telling tale after tale, recalling incident upon incident of long years before. At last they turned to memories of racing days at Market Milcaster. And at that Spargo determined on a bold stroke. Now was the time to get some information. Taking the silver ticket from his purse, he laid it, the heraldic device uppermost, on the palm of his hand, and approaching the group with a polite bow, said quietly: โGentlemen, can any of you tell me anything about that?โ Chapter 17 – Mr. Quarterpage Harks Back. If Spargo had upset the old gentlemenโs bowl of punchโthe second of the eveningโor had dropped an infernal machine in their midst, he could scarcely have produced a more startling effect than that wrought upon them by his sudden production of the silver ticket. Their babble of conversation died out; one of them dropped his pipe; another took his cigar out of his mouth as if he had suddenly discovered that he was sucking a stick of poison; all lifted astonished faces to the interrupter, staring from him to the shining object exhibited in his outstretched palm, from it back to him. And at last Mr. Quarterpage, to whom Spargo had more particularly addressed himself, spoke, pointing with great _empressement_ to the ticket. โYoung gentleman!โ he said, in accents that seemed to Spargo to tremble a little, โyoung gentleman, where did you get that?โ โYou know what it is, then?โ asked Spargo, willing to dally a little with the matter. โYou recognize it?โ โKnow it! Recognize it!โ exclaimed Mr. Quarterpage. โYes, and so does every gentleman present. And it is just because I see you are a stranger to this town that I ask you where you got it. Not, I think, young gentleman, in this town.โ โNo,โ replied Spargo. โCertainly not in this town. How should I get it in this town if Iโm a stranger?โ โQuite true, quite true!โ murmured Mr. Quarterpage. โI cannot conceive how any person in the town who is in possession of one of thoseโwhat shall we call themโheirlooms?โyes, heirlooms of antiquity, could possibly be base enough to part with it. Therefore, I ask againโWhere did you get that, young gentleman?โ โBefore I tell you that,โ answered Spargo, who, in answer to a silent sign from the fat man had drawn a chair amongst them, โperhaps you will tell me exactly what this is? I see it to be a bit of old, polished, much worn silver, having on the obverse the arms or heraldic bearings of somebody or something; on the reverse the figure of a running horse. Butโwhat is it?โ The five old men all glanced at each other and made simultaneous grunts. Then Mr. Quarterpage spoke. โIt is one of the original fifty burgess tickets of Market Milcaster, young sir, which gave its holder special and greatly valued privileges in respect to attendance at our once famous race-meeting, now unfortunately a thing of the past,โ he added. โFiftyโaye, forty!โyears ago, to be in possession of one of those tickets wasโwasโโ โA grand thing!โ said one of the old gentlemen. โMr. Lummis is right,โ said Mr. Quarterpage. โIt was a grand thingโa very grand thing. Those tickets, sir, were treasuredโare treasured. And yet you, a stranger, show us one! You got it, sirโโ Spargo saw that it was now necessary to cut matters short. โI found this ticketโunder mysterious circumstancesโin London,โ he answered. โI want to trace it. I want to know who its original owner was. That is why I have come to Market Milcaster.โ Mr. Quarterpage slowly looked round the circle of faces. โWonderful!โ he said. โWonderful! He found this ticketโone of our famous fiftyโin London, and under mysterious circumstances. He wants to trace itโhe wants to know to whom it belonged! That is why he has come to Market Milcaster. Most extraordinary! Gentlemen, I appeal to you if this is not the most extraordinary event that has happened in Market Milcaster forโI donโt know how many years?โ There was a general murmur of assent, and Spargo found everybody looking at him as if he had just announced that he had come to buy the whole town. โButโwhy?โ he asked, showing great surprise. โWhy?โ โWhy?โ exclaimed Mr. Quarterpage. โWhy? He asksโwhy? Because, young gentleman, it is the greatest surprise to me, and to these friends of mine, too, every man jack of ’em, to hear that any one of our fifty tickets ever passed out of the possession of any of the fifty families to whom they belonged! And unless I am vastly, greatly, most unexplainably mistaken, young sir, you are not a member of any Market Milcaster family.โ โNo, Iโm not,โ admitted Spargo. And he was going to add that until the previous evening he had never even heard of Market Milcaster, but he wisely refrained. โNo, Iโm certainly not,โ he added. Mr. Quarterpage waved his long pipe. โI believe,โ he said, โI believe that if the evening were not drawing to a closeโit is already within a few minutes of our departure, young gentlemanโI believe, I say, that if I had time, I could, from memory, give the names of the fifty families who held those tickets when the race-meeting came to an end. I believe I could!โ โIโm sure you could!โ asserted the little man in the loud suit. โNever was such a memory as yours, never!โ โEspecially for anything relating to the old racing matters,โ said the fat man. โMr. Quarterpage is a walking encyclopaedia.โ โMy memory is good,โ said Mr. Quarterpage. โItโs the greatest blessing I have in my declining years. Yes, I am sure I could do that, with a little thought. And whatโs more, nearly every one of those fifty families is still in the town, or if not in the town, close by it, or if not close by it, I know where they are. Therefore, I cannot make out how this young gentlemanโfrom London, did you say, sir?โ โFrom London,โ answered Spargo. โThis young gentleman from London comes to be in possession of one of our tickets,โ continued Mr. Quarterpage. โIt isโwonderful! But I tell you what, young gentleman from London, if you will do me the honour to breakfast with me in the morning, sir, I will show you my racing books and papers and we will speedily discover who the original holder of that ticket was. My name, sir, is QuarterpageโBenjamin Quarterpageโand I reside at the ivy-covered house exactly opposite this inn, and my breakfast hour is nine oโclock sharp, and I shall bid you heartily welcome!โ Spargo made his best bow. โSir,โ he said, โI am greatly obliged by your kind invitation, and I shall consider it an honour to wait upon you to the moment.โ Accordingly, at five minutes to nine next morning, Spargo found himself in an old-fashioned parlour, looking out upon a delightful garden, gay with summer flowers, and being introduced by Mr. Quarterpage, Senior, to Mr. Quarterpage, Juniorโa pleasant gentleman of sixty, always referred to by his father as something quite juvenileโand to Miss Quarterpage, a young-old lady of something a little less elderly than her brother, and to a breakfast table bounteously spread with all the choice fare of the season. Mr. Quarterpage, Senior, was as fresh and rosy as a cherub; it was a revelation to Spargo to encounter so old a man who was still in possession of such life and spirits, and of such a vigorous and healthy appetite. Naturally, the talk over the breakfast table ran on Spargoโs possession of the old silver ticket, upon which subject it was evident Mr. Quarterpage was still exercising his intellect. And Spargo, who had judged it well to enlighten his host as to who he was, and had exhibited a letter with which the editor of the _Watchman_ had furnished him, told how in the exercise of his journalistic duties he had discovered the ticket in the lining of an old box. But he made no mention of the Marbury matter, being anxious to see first whither Mr. Quarterpageโs revelations would lead him. โYou have no idea, Mr. Spargo,โ said the old gentleman, when, breakfast over, he and Spargo were closeted together in a little library in which were abundant evidences of the hostโs taste in sporting matters; โyou have no idea of the value which was attached to the possession of one of those silver tickets. There is mine, as you see, securely framed and just as securely fastened to the wall. Those fifty silver tickets, my dear sir, were made when our old race-meeting was initiated, in the year 1781. They were made in the town by a local silversmith, whose great-great-grandson still carries on the business. The fifty were distributed amongst the fifty leading burgesses of the town to be kept in their families for everโnobody ever anticipated in those days that our race-meeting would ever be discontinued. The ticket carried great privileges. It made its holder, and all members of his family, male and female, free of the stands, rings, and paddocks. It gave the holder himself and his eldest son, if of age, the right to a seat at our grand race banquetโat which, I may tell you, Mr. Spargo, Royalty itself has been present in the good old days. Consequently, as you see, to be the holder of a silver ticket was to be somebody.โ โAnd when the race-meeting fell through?โ asked Spargo. โWhat then?โ โThen, of course, the families who held the tickets looked upon them as heirlooms, to be taken great care of,โ replied Mr. Quarterpage. โThey were dealt with as I dealt with mineโframed on velvet, and hung upโor locked away: I am sure that anybody who had one took the greatest care of it. Now, I said last night, over there at the โDragon,โ that I could repeat the names of all the families who held these tickets. So I can. But hereโโthe old gentleman drew out a drawer and produced from it a parchment-bound book which he handled with great reverenceโโhere is a little volume of my own handwritingโmemoranda relating to Market Milcaster Racesโin which is a list of the original holders, together with another list showing who held the tickets when the races were given up. I make bold to say, Mr. Spargo, that by going through the second list, I could trace every ticketโexcept the one you have in your purse.โ โEvery one?โ said Spargo, in some surprise. โEvery one! For as I told you,โ continued Mr. Quarterpage, โthe families are either in the town (weโre a conservative people here in Market Milcaster and we donโt move far afield) or theyโre just outside the town, or theyโre not far away. I canโt conceive how the ticket you haveโand itโs genuine enoughโcould ever get out of possession of one of these families, andโโ โPerhaps,โ suggested Spargo, โit never has been out of possession. I told you it was found in the lining of a boxโthat box belonged to a dead man.โ โA dead man!โ exclaimed Mr. Quarterpage. โA dead man! Who couldโah! Perhapsโperhaps I have an idea. Yes!โan idea. I remember something now that I had never thought of.โ The old gentleman unfastened the clasp of his parchment-bound book, and turned over its pages until he came to one whereon was a list of names. He pointed this out to Spargo. โThere is the list of holders of the silver tickets at the time the race-meetings came to an end,โ he said. โIf you were acquainted with this town you would know that those are the names of our best-known inhabitantsโall, of course, burgesses. Thereโs mine, you seeโQuarterpage. Thereโs Lummis, thereโs Kaye, thereโs Skene, thereโs Templebyโthe gentlemen you saw last night. All good old town names. They all areโon this list. I know every family mentioned. The holders of that time are many of them dead; but their successors have the tickets. Yesโand now that I think of it, thereโs only one man who held a ticket when this list was made about whom I donโt know anythingโat least, anything recent. The ticket, Mr. Spargo, which youโve found must have been his. But I thoughtโI thought somebody else had it!โ โAnd this man, sir? Who was he?โ asked Spargo, intuitively conscious that he was coming to news. โIs his name there?โ The old man ran the tip of his finger down the list of names. โThere it is!โ he said. โJohn Maitland.โ Spargo bent over the fine writing. โYes, John Maitland,โ he observed. โAnd who was John Maitland?โ Mr. Quarterpage shook his head. He turned to another of the many drawers in an ancient bureau, and began to search amongst a mass of old newspapers, carefully sorted into small bundles and tied up. โIf you had lived in Market Milcaster one-and-twenty years ago, Mr. Spargo,โ he said, โyou would have known who John Maitland was. For some time, sir, he was the best-known man in the placeโaye, and in this corner of the world. Butโaye, here it isโthe newspaper of October 5th, 1891. Now, Mr. Spargo, youโll find in this old newspaper who John Maitland was, and all about him. Now, Iโll tell you what to do. Iโve just got to go into my office for an hour to talk the dayโs business over with my sonโyou take this newspaper out into the garden there with one of these cigars, and read whatโll you find in it, and when youโve read that weโll have some more talk.โ Spargo carried the old newspaper into the sunlit garden. Chapter 18 – An Old Newspaper. As soon as Spargo unfolded the paper he saw what he wanted on the middle page, headed in two lines of big capitals. He lighted a cigar and settled down to read. โMARKET MILCASTER QUARTER SESSIONS โTRIAL OF JOHN MAITLAND โThe Quarter Sessions for the Borough of Market Milcaster were held on Wednesday last, October 3rd, 1891, in the Town Hall, before the Recorder, Henry John Campernowne, Esq., K.C., who was accompanied on the bench by the Worshipful the Mayor of Market Milcaster (Alderman Pettiford), the Vicar of Market Milcaster (the Rev. P.B. Clabberton, M.A., R.D.), Alderman Banks, J.P., Alderman Peters, J.P., Sir Gervais Racton, J.P., Colonel Fludgate, J.P., Captain Murrill, J.P., and other magistrates and gentlemen. There was a crowded attendance of the public in anticipation of the trial of John Maitland, ex-manager of the Market Milcaster Bank, and the reserved portions of the Court were filled with the _รฉlite_ of the town and neighbourhood, including a considerable number of ladies who manifested the greatest interest in the proceedings. โThe Recorder, in charging the Grand Jury, said he regretted that the very pleasant and gratifying experience which had been his upon the occasion of his last two official visits to Market Milcasterโhe referred to the fact that on both those occasions his friend the Worshipful Mayor had been able to present him with a pair of white glovesโwas not to be repeated on the present occasion. It would be their sad and regrettable lot to have before them a fellow-townsman whose family had for generations occupied a foremost position in the life of the borough. That fellow-townsman was charged with one of the most serious offences known to a commercial nation like ours: the offence of embezzling the moneys of the bank of which he had for many years been the trusted manager, and with which he had been connected all his life since his school days. He understood that the prisoner who would shortly be put before the court on his trial was about to plead guilty, and there would accordingly be no need for him to direct the gentlemen of the Grand Jury on this matterโwhat he had to say respecting the gravity and even enormity of the offence he would reserve. The Recorder then addressed himself to the Grand Jury on the merits of two minor cases, which came before the court at a later period of the morning, after which they retired, and having formally returned a true bill against the prisoner, and a petty jury, chosen from well-known burgesses of the town having been duly sworn. โJOHN MAITLAND, aged 42, bank manager, of the Bank House, High Street, Market Milcaster, was formally charged with embezzling, on April 23rd, 1891, the sum of ยฃ4,875 10_s_. 6_d_., the moneys of his employers, the Market Milcaster Banking Company Ltd., and converting the same to his own use. The prisoner, who appeared to feel his position most acutely, and who looked very pale and much worn, was represented by Mr. Charles Doolittle, the well-known barrister of Kingshaven; Mr. Stephens, K.C., appeared on behalf of the prosecution. โMaitland, upon being charged, pleaded guilty. โMr. Stephens, K.C., addressing the Recorder, said that without any desire to unduly press upon the prisoner, who, he ventured to think, had taken a very wise course in pleading guilty to that particular count in the indictment with which he stood charged, he felt bound, in the interests of justice, to set forth to the Court some particulars of the defalcations which had arisen through the prisonerโs much lamented dishonesty. He proposed to offer a clear and succinct account of the matter. The prisoner, John Maitland, was the last of an old Market Milcaster familyโhe was, in fact, he believed, with the exception of his own infant son, the very last of the race. His father had been manager of the bank before him. Maitland himself had entered the service of the bank at the age of eighteen, when he left the local Grammar School; he succeeded his father as manager at the age of thirty-two; he had therefore occupied this highest position of trust for ten years. His directors had the fullest confidence in him; they relied on his honesty and his honour; they gave him discretionary powers such as no bank-manager, probably, ever enjoyed or held before. In fact, he was so trusted that he was, to all intents and purposes, the Market Milcaster Banking Company; in other words he was allowed full control over everything, and given full licence to do what he liked. Whether the directors were wise in extending such liberty to even the most trusted servant, it was not for him (Mr. Stephens) to say; it was some consolation, under the circumstances, to know that the loss would fall upon the directors, inasmuch as they themselves held nearly the whole of the shares. But he had to speak of the lossโof the serious defalcations which Maitland had committed. The prisoner had wisely pleaded guilty to the first count of the indictment. But there were no less than seventeen counts in the indictment. He had pleaded guilty to embezzling a sum of ยฃ4,875 odd. But the total amount of the defalcations, comprised in the seventeen counts, was no lessโit seemed a most amazing sum!โthan ยฃ221,573 8_s_. 6_d_.! There was the factโthe banking company had been robbed of over two hundred thousand pounds by the prisoner in the dock before a mere accident, the most trifling chance, had revealed to the astounded directors that he was robbing them at all. And the most serious feature of the whole case was that not one penny of this money had been, or ever could be, recovered. He believed that the prisonerโs learned counsel was about to urge upon the Court that the prisoner himself had been tricked and deceived by another man, unfortunately not before the Courtโa man, he understood, also well known in Market Milcaster, who was now dead, and therefore could not be called, but whether he was so tricked or deceived was no excuse for his clever and wholesale robbing of his employers. He had thought it necessary to put these factsโwhich would not be deniedโbefore the Court, in order that it might be known how heavy the defalcations really had been, and that they should be considered in dealing with the prisoner. โThe Recorder asked if there was no possibility of recovering any part of the vast sum concerned. โMr. Stephens replied that they were informed that there was not the remotest chanceโthe money, it was said by prisoner and those acting on his behalf, had utterly vanished with the death of the man to whom he had just made reference. โMr. Doolittle, on behalf of the prisoner, craved to address a few words to the Court in mitigation of sentence. He thanked Mr. Stephens for the considerate and eminently dispassionate manner in which he had outlined the main facts of the case. He had no desire to minimize the prisonerโs guilt. But, on prisonerโs behalf, he desired to tell the true story as to how these things came to be. Until as recently as three years previously the prisoner had never made the slightest deviation from the straight path of integrity. Unfortunately for him, and, he believed, for some others in Market Milcaster, there came to the town three years before the present proceedings, a man named Chamberlayne, who commenced business in the High Street as a stock-and-share broker. A man of good address and the most plausible manners, Chamberlayne attracted a good many peopleโamongst them his unfortunate client. It was matter of common knowledge that Chamberlayne had induced numerous persons in Market Milcaster to enter into financial transactions with him; it was matter of common repute that those transactions had not always turned out well for Chamberlayneโs clients. Unhappily for himself, Maitland had great faith in Chamberlayne. He had begun to have transactions with him in a large way; they had gone on and on in a large way until he was involved to vast amounts. Believing thoroughly in Chamberlayne and his methods, he had entrusted him with very large sums of money. โThe Recorder interrupted Mr. Doolittle at this point to ask if he was to understand that Mr. Doolittle was referring to the prisonerโs own money. โMr. Doolittle replied that he was afraid the large sums he referred to were the property of the bank. But the prisoner had such belief in Chamberlayne that he firmly anticipated that all would be well, and that these sums would be repaid, and that a vast profit would result from their use. โThe Recorder remarked that he supposed the prisoner intended to put the profit into his own pockets. โMr. Doolittle said at any rate the prisoner assured him that of the two hundred and twenty thousand pounds which was in question, Chamberlayne had had the immediate handling of at least two hundred thousand, and he, the prisoner, had not the ghost of a notion as to what Chamberlayne had done with it. Unfortunately for everybody, for the bank, for some other people, and especially for his unhappy client, Chamberlayne died, very suddenly, just as these proceedings were instituted, and so far it had been absolutely impossible to trace anything of the moneys concerned. He had died under mysterious circumstances, and there was just as much mystery about his affairs. โThe Recorder observed that he was still waiting to hear what Mr. Doolittle had to urge in mitigation of any sentence he, the Recorder, might think fit to pass. โMr. Doolittle said that he would trouble the Court with as few remarks as possible. All that he could urge on behalf of the unfortunate man in the dock was that until three years ago he had borne a most exemplary character, and had never committed a dishonest action. It had been his misfortune, his folly, to allow a plausible man to persuade him to these acts of dishonesty. That man had been called to another account, and the prisoner was left to bear the consequences of his association with him. It seemed as if Chamberlayne had made away with the money for his own purposes, and it might be that it would yet be recovered. He would only ask the Court to remember the prisonerโs antecedents and his previous good conduct, and to bear in mind that whatever his near future might be he was, in a commercial sense, ruined for life. โThe Recorder, in passing sentence, said that he had not heard a single word of valid excuse for Maitlandโs conduct. Such dishonesty must be punished in the most severe fashion, and the prisoner must go to penal servitude for ten years. โMaitland, who heard the sentence unmoved, was removed from the town later in the day to the county jail at Saxchester.โ Spargo read all this swiftly; then went over it again, noting certain points in it. At last he folded up the newspaper and turned to the houseโto see old Quarterpage beckoning to him from the library window. Chapter 19 – The Chamberlayne Story. โI perceive, sir,โ said Mr. Quarterpage, as Spargo entered the library, โthat you have read the account of the Maitland trial.โ โTwice,โ replied Spargo. โAnd you have come to the conclusion thatโbut what conclusion have you come to?โ asked Mr. Quarterpage. โThat the silver ticket in my purse was Maitlandโs property,โ said Spargo, who was not going to give all his conclusions at once. โJust so,โ agreed the old gentleman. โI think soโI canโt think anything else. But I was under the impression that I could have accounted for that ticket, just as I am sure I can account for the other forty-nine.โ โYesโand how?โ asked Spargo. Mr. Quarterpage turned to a corner cupboard and in silence produced a decanter and two curiously-shaped old wine-glasses. He carefully polished the glasses with a cloth which he took from a drawer, and set glasses and decanter on a table in the window, motioning Spargo to take a chair in proximity thereto. He himself pulled up his own elbow-chair. โWeโll take a glass of my old brown sherry,โ he said. โThough I say it as shouldnโt, as the saying goes, I donโt think you could find better brown sherry than that from Landโs End to Berwick-upon-Tweed, Mr. Spargoโno, nor further north either, where they used to have good taste in liquor in my young days! Well, hereโs your good health, sir, and Iโll tell you about Maitland.โ โIโm curious,โ said Spargo. โAnd about more than Maitland. I want to know about a lot of things arising out of that newspaper report. I want to know something about the man referred to so muchโthe stockbroker, Chamberlayne.โ โJust so,โ observed Mr. Quarterpage, smiling. โI thought that would touch your sense of the inquisitive. But Maitland first. Now, when Maitland went to prison, he left behind him a child, a boy, just then about two years old. The childโs mother was dead. Her sister, a Miss Baylis, appeared on the sceneโMaitland had married his wife from a distanceโand took possession of the child and of Maitlandโs personal effects. He had been made bankrupt while he was awaiting his trial, and all his household goods were sold. But this Miss Baylis took some small personal things, and I always believed that she took the silver ticket. And she may have done, for anything I know to the contrary. Anyway, she took the child away, and there was an end of the Maitland family in Market Milcaster. Maitland, of course, was in due procedure of things removed to Dartmoor, and there he served his term. There were people who were very anxious to get hold of him when he came outโthe bank people, for they believed that he knew more about the disposition of that money than heโd ever told, and they wanted to induce him to tell what they hoped he knewโbetween ourselves, Mr. Spargo, they were going to make it worth his while to tell.โ Spargo tapped the newspaper, which he had retained while the old gentleman talked. โThen they didnโt believe what his counsel saidโthat Chamberlayne got all the money?โ he asked. Mr. Quarterpage laughed. โNoโnor anybody else!โ he answered. โThere was a strong idea in the townโyouโll see why afterwardsโthat it was all a put-up job, and that Maitland cheerfully underwent his punishment knowing that there was a nice fortune waiting for him when he came out. And as I say, the bank people meant to get hold of him. But though they sent a special agent to meet him on his release, they never did get hold of him. Some mistake aroseโwhen Maitland was released, he got clear away. Nobodyโs ever heard a word of him from that day to this. Unless Miss Baylis has.โ โWhere does this Miss Baylis live?โ asked Spargo. โWell, I donโt know,โ replied Mr. Quarterpage. โShe did live in Brighton when she took the child away, and her address was known, and I have it somewhere. But when the bank people sought her out after Maitlandโs release, she, too, had clean disappeared, and all efforts to trace her failed. In fact, according to the folks who lived near her in Brighton, sheโd completely disappeared, with the child, five years before. So there wasnโt a clue to Maitland. He served his timeโmade a model prisonerโthey did find that much out!โearned the maximum remission, was released, and vanished. And for that very reason thereโs a theory about him in this very town to this very day!โ โWhat?โ asked Spargo. โThis. That heโs now living comfortably, luxuriously abroad on what he got from the bank,โ replied Mr. Quarterpage. โThey say that the sister-in-law was in at the game; that when she disappeared with the child, she went abroad somewhere and made a home ready for Maitland, and that he went off to them as soon as he came out. Do you see?โ โI suppose that was possible,โ said Spargo. โQuite possible, sir. But now,โ continued the old gentleman, replenishing the glasses, โnow we come on to the Chamberlayne story. Itโs a good deal more to do with the Maitland story than appears at first sight, Iโll tell it to you and you can form your own conclusions. Chamberlayne was a man who came to Market MilcasterโI donโt know from whereโin 1886โfive years before the Maitland smash-up. He was then about Maitlandโs ageโa man of thirty-seven or eight. He came as clerk to old Mr. Vallas, the rope and twine manufacturer: Vallasโs place is still there, at the bottom of the High Street, near the river, though old Vallas is dead. He was a smart, cute, pushing chap, this Chamberlayne; he made himself indispensable to old Vallas, and old Vallas paid him a rare good salary. He settled down in the town, and he married a town girl, one of the Corkindales, the saddlers, when heโd been here three years. Unfortunately she died in childbirth within a year of their marriage. It was very soon after that that Chamberlayne threw up his post at Vallasโs, and started business as a stock-and-share broker. Heโd been a saving man; heโd got a nice bit of money with his wife; he always let it be known that he had money of his own, and he started in a good way. He was a man of the most plausible manners: heโd have coaxed butter out of a dogโs throat if heโd wanted to. The moneyed men of the town believed in himโI believed in him myself, Mr. SpargoโIโd many a transaction with him, and I never lost aught by himโon the contrary, he did very well for me. He did well for most of his clientsโthere were, of course, ups and downs, but on the whole he satisfied his clients uncommonly well. But, naturally, nobody ever knew what was going on between him and Maitland.โ โI gather from this report,โ said Spargo, โthat everything came out suddenlyโunexpectedly?โ โThat was so, sir,โ replied Mr. Quarterpage. โSudden? Unexpected? Aye, as a crack of thunder on a fine winterโs day. Nobody had the ghost of a notion that anything was wrong. John Maitland was much respected in the town; much thought of by everybody; well known to everybody. I can assure you, Mr. Spargo, that it was no pleasant thing to have to sit on that grand jury as I didโI was its foreman, sir,โand hear a man sentenced that youโd regarded as a bosom friend. But there it was!โ โHow was the thing discovered?โ asked Spargo, anxious to get at facts. โIn this way,โ replied Mr. Quarterpage. โThe Market Milcaster Bank is in reality almost entirely the property of two old families in the town, the Gutchbys and the Hostables. Owing to the death of his father, a young Hostable, fresh from college, came into the business. He was a shrewd, keen young fellow; he got some suspicion, somehow, about Maitland, and he insisted on the other partners consenting to a special investigation, and on their making it suddenly. And Maitland was caught before he had a chance. But weโre talking about Chamberlayne.โ โYes, about Chamberlayne,โ agreed Spargo. โWell, now, Maitland was arrested one evening,โ continued Mr. Quarterpage. โOf course, the news of his arrest ran through the town like wild-fire. Everybody was astonished; he was at that timeโaye, and had been for yearsโa churchwarden at the Parish Church, and I donโt think there could have been more surprise if weโd heard that the Vicar had been arrested for bigamy. In a little town like this, news is all over the place in a few minutes. Of course, Chamberlayne would hear that news like everybody else. But it was remembered, and often remarked upon afterwards, that from the moment of Maitlandโs arrest nobody in Market Milcaster ever had speech with Chamberlayne again. After his wifeโs death heโd taken to spending an hour or so of an evening across there at the โDragon,โ where you saw me and my friends last night, but on that night he didnโt go to the โDragon.โ And next morning he caught the eight oโclock train to London. He happened to remark to the stationmaster as he got into the train that he expected to be back late that night, and that he should have a tiring day of it. But Chamberlayne didnโt come back that night, Mr. Spargo. He didnโt come back to Market Milcaster for four days, and when he did come back it was in a coffin!โ โDead?โ exclaimed Spargo. โThat was sudden!โ โVery sudden,โ agreed Mr. Quarterpage. โYes, sir, he came back in his coffin, did Chamberlayne. On the very evening on which heโd spoken of being back, there came a telegram here to say that heโd died very suddenly at the Cosmopolitan Hotel. That telegram came to his brother-in-law, Corkindale, the saddlerโyouโll find him down the street, opposite the Town Hall. It was sent to Corkindale by a nephew of Chamberlayneโs, another Chamberlayne, Stephen, who lived in London, and was understood to be on the Stock Exchange there. I saw that telegram, Mr. Spargo, and it was a long one. It said that Chamberlayne had had a sudden seizure, and though a doctor had been got to him heโd died shortly afterwards. Now, as Chamberlayne had his nephew and friends in London, his brother-in-law, Tom Corkindale, didnโt feel that there was any necessity for him to go up to town, so he just sent off a wire to Stephen Chamberlayne asking if there was aught he could do. And next morning came another wire from Stephen saying that no inquest would be necessary, as the doctor had been present and able to certify the cause of death, and would Corkindale make all arrangements for the funeral two days later. You see, Chamberlayne had bought a vault in our cemetery when he buried his wife, so naturally they wished to bury him in it, with her.โ Spargo nodded. He was beginning to imagine all sorts of things and theories; he was taking everything in. โWell,โ continued Mr. Quarterpage, โon the second day after that, they brought Chamberlayneโs body down. Three of ’em came with itโStephen Chamberlayne, the doctor whoโd been called in, and a solicitor. Everything was done according to proper form and usage. As Chamberlayne had been well known in the town, a good number of townsfolk met the body at the station and followed it to the cemetery. Of course, many of us who had been clients of Chamberlayneโs were anxious to know how he had come to such a sudden end. According to Stephen Chamberlayneโs account, our Chamberlayne had wired to him and to his solicitor to meet him at the Cosmopolitan to do some business. They were awaiting him there when he arrived, and they had lunch together. After that, they got to their business in a private room. Towards the end of the afternoon, Chamberlayne was taken suddenly ill, and though they got a doctor to him at once, he died before evening. The doctor said heโd a diseased heart. Anyhow, he was able to certify the cause of his death, so there was no inquest and they buried him, as I have told you.โ The old gentleman paused and, taking a sip at his sherry, smiled at some reminiscence which occurred to him. โWell,โ he said, presently going on, โof course, on that came all the Maitland revelations, and Maitland vowed and declared that Chamberlayne had not only had nearly all the money, but that he was absolutely certain that most of it was in his hands in hard cash. But Chamberlayne, Mr. Spargo, had left practically nothing. All that could be traced was about three or four thousand pounds. Heโd left everything to his nephew, Stephen. There wasnโt a trace, a clue to the vast sums with which Maitland had entrusted him. And then people began to talk, and they said what some of them say to this very day!โ โWhatโs that?โ asked Spargo. Mr. Quarterpage leaned forward and tapped his guest on the arm. โThat Chamberlayne never did die, and that that coffin was weighted with lead!โ he answered. Chapter 20 – Maitland alias Marbury. This remarkable declaration awoke such a new conception of matters in Spargoโs mind, aroused such infinitely new possibilities in his imagination, that for a full moment he sat silently staring at his informant, who chuckled with quiet enjoyment at his visitorโs surprise. โDo you mean to tell me,โ said Spargo at last, โthat there are people in this town who still believe that the coffin in your cemetery which is said to contain Chamberlayneโs body containsโlead?โ โLots of ’em, my dear sir!โ replied Mr. Quarterpage. โLots of ’em! Go out in the street and ask the first six men you meet, and Iโll go bail that four out of the six believe it.โ โThen why, in the sacred name of common sense did no one ever take steps to make certain?โ asked Spargo. โWhy didnโt they get an order for exhumation?โ โBecause it was nobodyโs particular business to do so,โ answered Mr. Quarterpage. โYou donโt know country-town life, my dear sir. In towns like Market Milcaster folks talk and gossip a great deal, but theyโre always slow to do anything. Itโs a case of whoโll start firstโof initiative. And if they see itโs going to cost anythingโthen theyโll have nothing to do with it.โ โButโthe bank people?โ suggested Spargo. Mr. Quarterpage shook his head. โTheyโre amongst the lot who believe that Chamberlayne did die,โ he said. โTheyโre very old-fashioned, conservative-minded people, the Gutchbys and the Hostables, and they accepted the version of the nephew, and the doctor, and the solicitor. But now Iโll tell you something about those three. There was a man here in the town, a gentleman of your own profession, who came to edit that paper youโve got on your knee. He got interested in this Chamberlayne case, and he began to make enquiries with the idea of getting hold of some goodโwhat do you call it?โ โI suppose heโd call it โcopy,โโ said Spargo. โโCopyโโthat was his term,โ agreed Mr. Quarterpage. โWell, he took the trouble to go to London to ask some quiet questions of the nephew, Stephen. That was just twelve months after Chamberlayne had been buried. But he found that Stephen Chamberlayne had left Englandโmonths before. Gone, they said, to one of the colonies, but they didnโt know which. And the solicitor had also gone. And the doctorโcouldnโt be traced, no, sir, not even through the Medical Register. What do you think of all that, Mr. Spargo?โ โI think,โ answered Spargo, โthat Market Milcaster folk are considerably slow. I should have had that death and burial enquired into. The whole thing looks to me like a conspiracy.โ โWell, sir, it was, as I say, nobodyโs business,โ said Mr. Quarterpage. โThe newspaper gentleman tried to stir up interest in it, but it was no good, and very soon afterwards he left. And there it is.โ โMr. Quarterpage,โ said Spargo, โwhatโs your own honest opinion?โ The old gentleman smiled. โAh!โ he said. โIโve often wondered, Mr. Spargo, if I really have an opinion on that point. I think that what I probably feel about the whole affair is that there was a good deal of mystery attaching to it. But we seem, sir, to have gone a long way from the question of that old silver ticket which youโve got in your purse. Nowโโโ โNo!โ said Spargo, interrupting his host with an accompanying wag of his forefinger. โNo! I think weโre coming nearer to it. Now youโve given me a great deal of your time, Mr. Quarterpage, and told me a lot, and, first of all, before I tell you a lot, Iโm going to show you something.โ And Spargo took out of his pocket-book a carefully-mounted photograph of John Marburyโthe original of the process-picture which he had had made for the _Watchman_. He handed it over. โDo you recognize that photograph as that of anybody you know?โ he asked. โLook at it well and closely.โ Mr. Quarterpage put on a special pair of spectacles and studied the photograph from several points of view. โNo, sir,โ he said at last with a shake of the head. โI donโt recognize it at all.โ โCanโt see in it any resemblance to any man youโve ever known?โ asked Spargo. โNo, sir, none!โ replied Mr. Quarterpage. โNone whatever.โ โVery well,โ said Spargo, laying the photograph on the table between them. โNow, then, I want you to tell me what John Maitland was like when you knew him. Also, I want you to describe Chamberlayne as he was when he died, or was supposed to die. You remember them, of course, quite well?โ Mr. Quarterpage got up and moved to the door. โI can do better than that,โ he said. โI can show you photographs of both men as they were just before Maitlandโs trial. I have a photograph of a small group of Market Milcaster notabilities which was taken at a municipal garden-party; Maitland and Chamberlayne are both in it. Itโs been put away in a cabinet in my drawing-room for many a long year, and Iโve no doubt itโs as fresh as when it was taken.โ He left the room and presently returned with a large mounted photograph which he laid on the table before his visitor. โThere you are, sir,โ he said. โQuite fresh, you seeโit must be getting on to twenty years since that was taken out of the drawer that itโs been kept in. Now, thatโs Maitland. And thatโs Chamberlayne.โ Spargo found himself looking at a group of men who stood against an ivy-covered wall in the stiff attitudes in which photographers arrange masses of sitters. He fixed his attention on the two figures indicated by Mr. Quarterpage, and saw two medium-heighted, rather sturdily-built men about whom there was nothing very specially noticeable. โUm!โ he said, musingly. โBoth bearded.โ โYes, they both wore beardsโfull beards,โ assented Mr. Quarterpage. โAnd you see, they werenโt so much alike. But Maitland was a much darker man than Chamberlayne, and he had brown eyes, while Chamberlayneโs were rather a bright blue.โ โThe removal of a beard makes a great difference,โ remarked Spargo. He looked at the photograph of Maitland in the group, comparing it with that of Marbury which he had taken from his pocket. โAnd twenty years makes a difference, too,โ he added musingly. โTo some people twenty years makes a vast difference, sir,โ said the old gentleman. โTo others it makes noneโI havenโt changed much, they tell me, during the past twenty years. But Iโve known men changeโage, almost beyond recognition!โin five years. It depends, sir, on what they go through.โ Spargo suddenly laid aside the photographs, put his hands in his pockets, and looked steadfastly at Mr. Quarterpage. โLook here!โ he said. โIโm going to tell you what Iโm after, Mr. Quarterpage. Iโm sure youโve heard all about whatโs known as the Middle Temple Murderโthe Marbury case?โ โYes, Iโve read of it,โ replied Mr. Quarterpage. โHave you read the accounts of it in my paper, the _Watchman_?โ asked Spargo. Mr. Quarterpage shook his head. โIโve only read one newspaper, sir, since I was a young man,โ he replied. โI take the _Times_, sirโwe always took it, aye, even in the days when newspapers were taxed.โ โVery good,โ said Spargo. โBut perhaps I can tell you a little more than youโve read, for Iโve been working up that case ever since the body of the man known as John Marbury was found. Now, if youโll just give me your attention, Iโll tell you the whole story from that moment untilโnow.โ And Spargo, briefly, succinctly, re-told the story of the Marbury case from the first instant of his own connection with it until the discovery of the silver ticket, and Mr. Quarterpage listened in rapt attention, nodding his head from time to time as the younger man made his points. โAnd now, Mr. Quarterpage,โ concluded Spargo, โthis is the point Iโve come to. I believe that the man who came to the Anglo-Orient Hotel as John Marbury and who was undoubtedly murdered in Middle Temple Lane that night, was John MaitlandโI havenโt a doubt about it after learning what you tell me about the silver ticket. Iโve found out a great deal thatโs valuable here, and I think Iโm getting nearer to a solution of the mystery. That is, of course, to find out who murdered John Maitland, or Marbury. What you have told me about the Chamberlayne affair has led me to think thisโthere may have been people, or a person, in London, who was anxious to get Marbury, as weโll call him, out of the way, and who somehow encountered him that nightโanxious to silence him, I mean, because of the Chamberlayne affair. And I wondered, as there is so much mystery about him, and as he wonโt give any account of himself, if this man Aylmore was really Chamberlayne. Yes, I wondered that! But Aylmoreโs a tall, finely-built man, quite six feet in height, and his beard, though itโs now getting grizzled, has been very dark, and Chamberlayne, you say, was a medium-sized, fair man, with blue eyes.โ โThatโs so, sir,โ assented Mr. Quarterpage. โYes, a middling-sized man, and fairโvery fair. Deary me, Mr. Spargo!โthis is a revelation. And you really think, sir, that John Maitland and John Marbury are one and the same person?โ โIโm sure of it, now,โ said Spargo. โI see it in this way. Maitland, on his release, went out to Australia, and there he stopped. At last he comes back, evidently well-to-do. Heโs murdered the very day of his arrival. Aylmore is the only man who knows anything of himโAylmore wonโt tell all he knows; thatโs flat. But Aylmoreโs admitted that he knew him at some vague date, say from twenty-one to twenty-two or three years ago. Now, where did Aylmore know him? He says in London. Thatโs a vague term. He wonโt say whereโhe wonโt say anything definiteโhe wonโt even say what he, Aylmore, himself was in those days. Do you recollect anything of anybody like Aylmore coming here to see Maitland, Mr. Quarterpage?โ โI donโt,โ answered Mr. Quarterpage. โMaitland was a very quiet, retiring fellow, sir: he was about the quietest man in the town. I never remember that he had visitors; certainly Iโve no recollection of such a friend of his as this Aylmore, from your description of him, would be at that time.โ โDid Maitland go up to London much in those days?โ asked Spargo. Mr. Quarterpage laughed. โWell, now, to show you what a good memory I have,โ he said, โIโll tell you of something that occurred across there at the โDragonโ only a few months before the Maitland affair came out. There were some of us in there one evening, and, for a rare thing, Maitland came in with Chamberlayne. Chamberlayne happened to remark that he was going up to town next dayโhe was always to and froโand we got talking about London. And Maitland said in course of conversation, that he believed he was about the only man of his age in Englandโand, of course, he meant of his class and meansโwhoโd never even seen London! And I donโt think he ever went there between that time and his trial: in fact, Iโm sure he didnโt, for if he had, I should have heard of it.โ โWell, thatโs queer,โ remarked Spargo. โItโs very queer. For Iโm certain Maitland and Marbury are one and the same person. My theory about that old leather box is that Maitland had that carefully planted before his arrest; that he dug it up when he came put of Dartmoor; that he took it off to Australia with him; that he brought it back with him; and that, of course, the silver ticket and the photograph had been in it all these years. Nowโโโ At that moment the door of the library was opened, and a parlourmaid looked in at her master. โThereโs the boots from the โDragonโ at the front door, sir,โ she said. โHeโs brought two telegrams across from there for Mr. Spargo, thinking he might like to have them at once.โ Chapter 21 – Arrested. Spargo hurried out to the hall, took the two telegrams from the boots of the โDragon,โ and, tearing open the envelopes, read the messages hastily. He went back to Mr. Quarterpage. โHereโs important news,โ he said as he closed the library door and resumed his seat. โIโll read these telegrams to you, sir, and then we can discuss them in the light of what weโve been talking about this morning. The first is from our office. I told you we sent over to Australia for a full report about Marbury at the place he said he hailed fromโCoolumbidgee. That reportโs just reached the _Watchman_, and theyโve wired it on to me. Itโs from the chief of police at Coolumbidgee to the editor of the _Watchman_, London:โ โJohn Marbury came to Coolumbidgee in the winter of 1898-9. He was unaccompanied. He appeared to be in possession of fairly considerable means and bought a share in a small sheep-farm from its proprietor, Andrew Robertson, who is still here, and who says that Marbury never told him anything about himself except that he had emigrated for health reasons and was a widower. He mentioned that he had had a son who was dead, and was now without relations. He lived a very quiet, steady life on the sheep-farm, never leaving it for many years. About six months ago, however, he paid a visit to Melbourne, and on returning told Robertson that he had decided to return to England in consequence of some news he had received, and must therefore sell his share in the farm. Robertson bought it from him for three thousand pounds, and Marbury shortly afterwards left for Melbourne. From what we could gather, Robertson thinks Marbury was probably in command of five or six thousand when he left Coolumbidgee. He told Robertson that he had met a man in Melbourne who had given him news that surprised him, but did not say what news. He had in his possession when he left Robertson exactly the luggage he brought with him when he cameโa stout portmanteau and a small, square leather box. There are no effects of his left behind at Coolumbidgee.โ โThatโs all,โ said Spargo, laying the first of the telegrams on the table. โAnd it seems to me to signify a good deal. But now hereโs more startling news. This is from Rathbury, the Scotland Yard detective that I told you of, Mr. Quarterpageโhe promised, you know, to keep me posted in what went on in my absence. Hereโs what he says: โFresh evidence tending to incriminate Aylmore has come to hand. Authorities have decided to arrest him on suspicion. Youโd better hurry back if you want material for to-morrowโs paper.โ Spargo threw that telegram down, too, waited while the old gentleman glanced at both of them with evident curiosity, and then jumped up. โWell, I shall have to go, Mr. Quarterpage,โ he said. โI looked the trains out this morning so as to be in readiness. I can catch the 1.20 to Paddingtonโthatโll get me in before half-past four. Iโve an hour yet. Now, thereโs another man I want to see in Market Milcaster. Thatโs the photographerโor a photographer. You remember I told you of the photograph found with the silver ticket? Well, Iโm calculating that that photograph was taken here, and I want to see the man who took itโif heโs alive and I can find him.โ Mr. Quarterpage rose and put on his hat. โThereโs only one photographer in this town, sir,โ he said, โand heโs been here for a good many yearsโCooper. Iโll take you to himโitโs only a few doors away.โ Spargo wasted no time in letting the photographer know what he wanted. He put a direct question to Mr. Cooperโan elderly man. โDo you remember taking a photograph of the child of John Maitland, the bank manager, some twenty or twenty-one years ago?โ he asked, after Mr. Quarterpage had introduced him as a gentleman from London who wanted to ask a few questions. โQuite well, sir,โ replied Mr. Cooper. โAs well as if it had been yesterday.โ โDo you still happen to have a copy of it?โ asked Spargo. But Mr. Cooper had already turned to a row of file albums. He took down one labelled 1891, and began to search its pages. In a minute or two he laid it on his table before his callers. โThere you are, sir,โ he said. โThatโs the child!โ Spargo gave one glance at the photograph and turned to Mr. Quarterpage. โJust as I thought,โ he said. โThatโs the same photograph we found in the leather box with the silver ticket. Iโm obliged to you, Mr. Cooper. Now, thereโs just one more question I want to ask. Did you ever supply any further copies of this photograph to anybody after the Maitland affair?โthat is; after the family had left the town?โ โYes,โ replied the photographer. โI supplied half a dozen copies to Miss Baylis, the childโs aunt, who, as a matter of fact, brought him here to be photographed. And I can give you her address, too,โ he continued, beginning to turn over another old file. โI have it somewhere.โ Mr. Quarterpage nudged Spargo. โThatโs something I couldnโt have done!โ he remarked. โAs I told you, sheโd disappeared from Brighton when enquiries were made after Maitlandโs release.โ โHere you are,โ said Mr. Cooper. โI sent six copies of that photograph to Miss Baylis in April, 1895. Her address was then 6, Chichester Square, Bayswater, W.โ Spargo rapidly wrote this address down, thanked the photographer for his courtesy, and went out with Mr. Quarterpage. In the street he turned to the old gentleman with a smile. โWell, I donโt think thereโs much doubt about that!โ he exclaimed. โMaitland and Marbury are the same man, Mr. Quarterpage. Iโm as certain of that as that I see your Town Hall there.โ โAnd what will you do next, sir?โ enquired Mr. Quarterpage. โThank youโas I doโfor all your kindness and assistance, and get off to town by this 1.20,โ replied Spargo. โAnd I shanโt fail to let you know how things go on.โ โOne moment,โ said the old gentleman, as Spargo was hurrying away, โdo you think this Mr. Aylmore really murdered Maitland?โ โNo!โ answered Spargo with emphasis. โI donโt! And I think weโve got a good deal to do before we find out who did.โ Spargo purposely let the Marbury case drop out of his mind during his journey to town. He ate a hearty lunch in the train and talked with his neighbours; it was a relief to let his mind and attention turn to something else than the theme which had occupied it unceasingly for so many days. But at Reading the newspaper boys were shouting the news of the arrest of a Member of Parliament, and Spargo, glancing out of the window, caught sight of a newspaper placard: THE MARBURY MURDER CASE ARREST OF MR. AYLMORE He snatched a paper from a boy as the train moved out and, unfolding it, found a mere announcement in the space reserved for stop-press news: โMr. Stephen Aylmore, M.P., was arrested at two oโclock this afternoon, on his way to the House of Commons, on a charge of being concerned in the murder of John Marbury in Middle Temple Lane on the night of June 21st last. It is understood he will be brought up at Bow Street at ten oโclock tomorrow morning.โ Spargo hurried to New Scotland Yard as soon as he reached Paddington. He met Rathbury coming away from his room. At sight of him, the detective turned back. โWell, so there you are!โ he said. โI suppose youโve heard the news?โ Spargo nodded as he dropped into a chair. โWhat led to it?โ he asked abruptly. โThere must have been something.โ โThere was something,โ he replied. โThe thingโstick, bludgeon, whatever you like to call it, some foreign articleโwith which Marbury was struck down was found last night.โ โWell?โ asked Spargo. โIt was proved to be Aylmoreโs property,โ answered Rathbury. โIt was a South American curio that he had in his rooms in Fountain Court.โ โWhere was it found?โ asked Spargo. Rathbury laughed. โHe was a clumsy fellow who did it, whether he was Aylmore or whoever he was!โ he replied. โDo you know, it had been dropped into a sewer-trap in Middle Temple Laneโactually! Perhaps the murderer thought it would be washed out into the Thames and float away. But, of course, it was bound to come to light. A sewer man found it yesterday evening, and it was quickly recognized by the woman who cleans up for Aylmore as having been in his rooms ever since she knew them. โWhat does Aylmore say about it?โ asked Spargo. โI suppose heโs said something?โ โSays that the bludgeon is certainly his, and that he brought it from South America with him,โ announced Rathbury; โbut that he doesnโt remember seeing it in his rooms for some time, and thinks that it was stolen from them.โ โUm!โ said Spargo, musingly. โButโhow do you know that was the thing that Marbury was struck down with?โ Rathbury smiled grimly. โThereโs some of his hair on itโmixed with blood,โ he answered. โNo doubt about that. Wellโanything come of your jaunt westward?โ โYes,โ replied Spargo. โLots!โ โGood?โ asked Rathbury. โExtra good. Iโve found out who Marbury really was.โ โNo! Really?โ โNo doubt, to my mind. Iโm certain of it.โ Rathbury sat down at his desk, watching Spargo with rapt attention. โAnd who was he?โ he asked. โJohn Maitland, once of Market Milcaster,โ replied Spargo. โEx-bank manager. Also ex-convict.โ โEx-convict!โ โEx-convict. He was sentenced, at Market Milcaster Quarter Sessions, in autumn, 1891, to ten yearsโ penal servitude, for embezzling the bankโs money, to the tune of over two hundred thousand pounds. Served his term at Dartmoor. Went to Australia as soon, or soon after, he came out. Thatโs who Marbury wasโMaitland. Deadโcertain!โ Rathbury still stared at his caller. โGo on!โ he said. โTell all about it, Spargo. Letโs hear every detail. Iโll tell you all I know after. But what I knowโs nothing to that.โ Spargo told him the whole story of his adventures at Market Milcaster, and the detective listened with rapt attention. โYes,โ he said at the end. โYesโI donโt think thereโs much doubt about that. Well, that clears up a lot, doesnโt it?โ Spargo yawned. โYes, a whole slate full is wiped off there,โ he said. โI havenโt so much interest in Marbury, or Maitland now. My interest is all in Aylmore.โ Rathbury nodded. โYes,โ he said. โThe thing to find out isโwho is Aylmore, or who was he, twenty years ago?โ โYour people havenโt found anything out, then?โ asked Spargo. โNothing beyond the irreproachable history of Mr. Aylmore since he returned to this country, a very rich man, some ten years since,โ answered Rathbury, smiling. โTheyโve no previous dates to go on. What are you going to do next, Spargo?โ โSeek out that Miss Baylis,โ replied Spargo. โYou think you could get something there?โ asked Rathbury. โLook here!โ said Spargo. โI donโt believe for a second Aylmore killed Marbury. I believe I shall get at the truth by following up what I call the Maitland trail. This Miss Baylis must know somethingโif sheโs alive. Well, now Iโm going to report at the office. Keep in touch with me, Rathbury.โ He went on then to the _Watchman_ office, and as he got out of his taxi-cab at its door, another cab came up and set down Mr. Aylmoreโs daughters. Chapter 22 – The Blank Past. Jessie Aylmore came forward to meet Spargo with ready confidence; the elder girl hung back diffidently. โMay we speak to you?โ said Jessie. โWe have come on purpose to speak to you. Evelyn didnโt want to come, but I made her come.โ Spargo shook hands silently with Evelyn Aylmore and motioned them both to follow him. He took them straight upstairs to his room and bestowed them in his easiest chairs before he addressed them. โIโve only just got back to town,โ he said abruptly. โI was sorry to hear the news about your father. Thatโs whatโs brought you here, of course. ButโIโm afraid I canโt do much.โ โI told you that we had no right to trouble Mr. Spargo, Jessie,โ said Evelyn Aylmore. โWhat can he do to help us?โ Jessie shook her head impatiently. โThe _Watchmanโs_ about the most powerful paper in London, isnโt it?โ she said. โAnd isnโt Mr. Spargo writing all these articles about the Marbury case? Mr. Spargo, you must help us!โ Spargo sat down at his desk and began turning over the letters and papers which had accumulated during his absence. โTo be absolutely frank with you,โ he said, presently, โI donโt see how anybodyโs going to help, so long as your father keeps up that mystery about the past.โ โThat,โ said Evelyn, quietly, โis exactly what Ronald says, Jessie. But we canโt make our father speak, Mr. Spargo. That he is as innocent as we are of this terrible crime we are certain, and we donโt know why he wouldnโt answer the questions put to him at the inquest. Andโwe know no more than you know or anyone knows, and though I have begged my father to speak, he wonโt say a word. We saw his danger: RonaldโMr. Bretonโtold us, and we implored him to tell everything he knew about Mr. Marbury. But so far he has simply laughed at the idea that he had anything to do with the murder, or could be arrested for it, and nowโโโ โAnd now heโs locked up,โ said Spargo in his usual matter-of-fact fashion. โWell, there are people who have to be saved from themselves, you know. Perhaps youโll have to save your father from the consequences of his ownโshall we say obstinacy? Now, look here, between ourselves, how much do you know about your fatherโsโpast?โ The two sisters looked at each other and then at Spargo. โNothing,โ said the elder. โAbsolutely nothing!โ said the younger. โAnswer a few plain questions,โ said Spargo. โIโm not going to print your replies, nor make use of them in any way: Iโm only asking the questions with a desire to help you. Have you any relations in England?โ โNone that we know of,โ replied Evelyn. โNobody you could go to for information about the past?โ asked Spargo. โNoโnobody!โ Spargo drummed his fingers on his blotting-pad. He was thinking hard. โHow old is your father?โ he asked suddenly. โHe was fifty-nine a few weeks ago,โ answered Evelyn. โAnd how old are you, and how old is your sister?โ demanded Spargo. โI am twenty, and Jessie is nearly nineteen.โ โWhere were you born?โ โBoth of us at San Gregorio, which is in the San Josรฉ province of Argentina, north of Monte Video.โ โYour father was in business there?โ โHe was in business in the export trade, Mr. Spargo. Thereโs no secret about that. He exported all sorts of things to England and to Franceโskins, hides, wools, dried salts, fruit. Thatโs how he made his money.โ โYou donโt know how long heโd been there when you were born?โ โNo.โ โWas he married when he went out there?โ โNo, he wasnโt. We do know that. Heโs told us the circumstances of his marriage, because they were romantic. When he sailed from England to Buenos Ayres, he met on the steamer a young lady who, he said, was like himself, relationless and nearly friendless. She was going out to Argentina as a governess. She and my father fell in love with each other, and they were married in Buenos Ayres soon after the steamer arrived.โ โAnd your mother is dead?โ โMy mother died before we came to England. I was eight years old, and Jessie six, then.โ โAnd you came to Englandโhow long after that?โ โTwo years.โ โSo that youโve been in England ten years. And you know nothing whatever of your fatherโs past beyond what youโve told me?โ โNothingโabsolutely nothing.โ โNever heard him talk ofโyou see, according to your account, your father was a man of getting on to forty when he went out to Argentina. He must have had a career of some sort in this country. Have you never heard him speak of his boyhood? Did he never talk of old times, or that sort of thing?โ โI never remember hearing my father speak of any period antecedent to his marriage,โ replied Evelyn. โI once asked him a question about his childhood.โ said Jessie. โHe answered that his early days had not been very happy ones, and that he had done his best to forget them. So I never asked him anything again.โ โSo that it really comes to this,โ remarked Spargo. โYou know nothing whatever about your father, his family, his fortunes, his life, beyond what you yourselves have observed since you were able to observe? Thatโs about it, isnโt it?โ โI should say that that is exactly it,โ answered Evelyn. โJust so,โ said Spargo. โAnd therefore, as I told your sister the other day, the public will say that your father has some dark secret behind him, and that Marbury had possession of it, and that your father killed him in order to silence him. That isnโt my view. I not only believe your father to be absolutely innocent, but I believe that he knows no more than a child unborn of Marburyโs murder, and Iโm doing my best to find out who that murderer was. By the by, since youโll see all about it in tomorrow morningโs _Watchman_, I may as well tell you that Iโve found out who Marbury really was. Heโโโ At this moment Spargoโs door was opened and in walked Ronald Breton. He shook his head at sight of the two sisters. โI thought I should find you here,โ he said. โJessie said she was coming to see you, Spargo. I donโt know what good you can doโI donโt see what good the most powerful newspaper in the world can do. My God!โeverythingโs about as black as ever it can be. Mr. AylmoreโIโve just come away from him; his solicitor, Stratton, and I have been with him for an hourโis obstinate as everโhe will not tell more than he has told. Whatever good can you do, Spargo, when he wonโt speak about that knowledge of Marbury which he must have?โ โOh, well!โ said Spargo. โPerhaps we can give him some information about Marbury. Mr. Aylmore has forgotten that itโs not such a difficult thing to rake up the past as he seems to think it is. For example, as I was just telling these young ladies, I myself have discovered who Marbury really was.โ Breton started. โYou have? Without doubt?โ he exclaimed. โWithout reasonable doubt. Marbury was an ex-convict.โ Spargo watched the effect of this sudden announcement. The two girls showed no sign of astonishment or of unusual curiosity; they received the news with as much unconcern as if Spargo had told them that Marbury was a famous musician. But Ronald Breton started, and it seemed to Spargo that he saw a sense of suspicion dawn in his eyes. โMarburyโan ex-convict!โ he exclaimed. โYou mean that?โ โRead your _Watchman_ in the morning,โ said Spargo. โYouโll find the whole story thereโIโm going to write it tonight when you people have gone. Itโll make good reading. โ Evelyn and Jessie Aylmore took Spargoโs hint and went away, Spargo seeing them to the door with another assurance of his belief in their fatherโs innocence and his determination to hunt down the real criminal. Ronald Breton went down with them to the street and saw them into a cab, but in another minute he was back in Spargoโs room as Spargo had expected. He shut the door carefully behind him and turned to Spargo with an eager face. โI say, Spargo, is that really so?โ he asked. โAbout Marbury being an ex-convict?โ โThatโs so, Breton. Iโve no more doubt about it than I have that I see you. Marbury was in reality one John Maitland, a bank manager, of Market Milcaster, who got ten yearsโ penal servitude in 1891 for embezzlement.โ โIn 1891? Whyโthatโs just about the time that Aylmore says he knew him!โ โExactly. Andโit just strikes me,โ said Spargo, sitting down at his desk and making a hurried note, โit just strikes meโdidnโt Aylmore say he knew Marbury in London?โ โCertainly,โ replied Breton. โIn London.โ โUm!โ mused Spargo. โThatโs queer, because Maitland had never been in London up to the time of his going to Dartmoor, whatever he may have done when he came out of Dartmoor, and, of course, Aylmore had gone to South America long before that. Look here, Breton,โ he continued, aloud, โhave you access to Aylmore? Will you, can you, see him before heโs brought up at Bow Street tomorrow?โ โYes,โ answered Breton. โI can see him with his solicitor.โ โThen listen,โ said Spargo. โTomorrow morning youโll find the whole story of how I proved Marburyโs identity with Maitland in the _Watchman_. Read it as early as you can; get an interview with Aylmore as early as you can; make him read it, every word, before heโs brought up. Beg him if he values his own safety and his daughtersโ peace of mind to throw away all that foolish reserve, and to tell all he knows about Maitland twenty years ago. He should have done that at first. Why, I was asking his daughters some questions before you came inโthey know absolutely nothing of their fatherโs history previous to the time when they began to understand things! Donโt you see that Aylmoreโs career, previous to his return to England, is a blank past!โ โI knowโI know!โ said Breton. โYesโalthough Iโve gone there a great deal, I never heard Aylmore speak of anything earlier than his Argentine experiences. And yet, he must have been getting on when he went out there.โ โThirty-seven or eight, at least,โ remarked Spargo. โWell, Aylmoreโs more or less of a public man, and no public man can keep his life hidden nowadays. By the by, how did you get to know the Aylmores?โ โMy guardian, Mr. Elphick, and I met them in Switzerland,โ answered Breton. โWe kept up the acquaintance after our return.โ โMr. Elphick still interesting himself in the Marbury case?โ asked Spargo. โVery much so. And so is old Cardlestone, at the foot of whose stairs the thing came off. I dined with them last night and they talked of little else,โ said Breton. โAnd their theoryโโ โOh, still the murder for the sake of robbery!โ replied Breton. โOld Cardlestone is furious that such a thing could have happened at his very door. He says that there ought to be a thorough enquiry into every tenant of the Temple.โ โLongish business that,โ observed Spargo. โWell, run away now, BretonโI must write.โ โShall you be at Bow Street tomorrow morning?โ asked Breton as he moved to the door. โItโs to be at ten-thirty.โ โNo, I shanโt!โ replied Spargo. โItโll only be a remand, and I know already just as much as I should hear there. Iโve got something much more important to do. But youโll remember what I asked of youโget Aylmore to read my story in the _Watchman_, and beg him to speak out and tell all he knowsโall!โ And when Breton had gone, Spargo again murmured those last words: โAll he knowsโall!โ Chapter 23 – Miss Baylis. Next day, a little before noon, Spargo found himself in one of those pretentious yet dismal Bayswater squares, which are almost entirely given up to the trade, calling, or occupation of the lodging and boarding-house keeper. They are very pretentious, those squares, with their many-storied houses, their stuccoed frontages, and their pilastered and balconied doorways; innocent country folk, coming into them from the neighbouring station of Paddington, take them to be the residences of the dukes and earls who, of course, live nowhere else but in London. They are further encouraged in this belief by the fact that young male persons in evening dress are often seen at the doorways in more or less elegant attitudes. These, of course, are taken by the country folk to be young lords enjoying the air of Bayswater, but others, more knowing, are aware that they are Swiss or German waiters whose linen might be cleaner. Spargo gauged the character of the house at which he called as soon as the door was opened to him. There was the usual smell of eggs and bacon, of fish and chops; the usual mixed and ancient collection of overcoats, wraps, and sticks in the hall; the usual sort of parlourmaid to answer the bell. And presently, in answer to his enquiries, there was the usual type of landlady confronting him, a more than middle-aged person who desired to look younger, and made attempts in the way of false hair, teeth, and a little rouge, and who wore that somewhat air and smile which in its wearerโunder these circumstancesโalways means that she is considering whether you will be able to cheat her or whether she will be able to see you. โYou wish to see Miss Baylis?โ said this person, examining Spargo closely. โMiss Baylis does not often see anybody.โ โI hope,โ said Spargo politely, โthat Miss Baylis is not an invalid?โ โNo, sheโs not an invalid,โ replied the landlady; โbut sheโs not as young as she was, and sheโs an objection to strangers. Is it anything I can tell her?โ โNo,โ said Spargo. โBut you can, if you please, take her a message from me. Will you kindly give her my card, and tell her that I wish to ask her a question about John Maitland of Market Milcaster, and that I should be much obliged if she would give me a few minutes.โ โPerhaps you will sit down,โ said the landlady. She led Spargo into a room which opened out upon a garden; in it two or three old ladies, evidently inmates, were sitting. The landlady left Spargo to sit with them and to amuse himself by watching them knit or sew or read the papers, and he wondered if they always did these things every day, and if they would go on doing them until a day would come when they would do them no more, and he was beginning to feel very dreary when the door opened and a woman entered whom Spargo, after one sharp glance at her, decided to be a person who was undoubtedly out of the common. And as she slowly walked across the room towards him he let his first glance lengthen into a look of steady inspection. The woman whom Spargo thus narrowly inspected was of very remarkable appearance. She was almost masculine; she stood nearly six feet in height; she was of a masculine gait and tread, and spare, muscular, and athletic. What at once struck Spargo about her face was the strange contrast between her dark eyes and her white hair; the hair, worn in abundant coils round a well-shaped head, was of the most snowy whiteness; the eyes of a real coal-blackness, as were also the eyebrows above them. The features were well-cut and of a striking firmness; the jaw square and determined. And Spargoโs first thought on taking all this in was that Miss Baylis seemed to have been fitted by Nature to be a prison wardress, or the matron of a hospital, or the governess of an unruly girl, and he began to wonder if he would ever manage to extract anything out of those firmly-locked lips. Miss Baylis, on her part, looked Spargo over as if she was half-minded to order him to instant execution. And Spargo was so impressed by her that he made a profound bow and found a difficulty in finding his tongue. โMr. Spargo?โ she said in a deep voice which seemed peculiarly suited to her. โOf, I see, the _Watchman_? You wish to speak to me?โ Spargo again bowed in silence. She signed him to the window near which they were standing. โOpen the casement, if you please,โ she commanded him. โWe will walk in the garden. This is not private.โ Spargo obediently obeyed her orders; she swept through the opened window and he followed her. It was not until they had reached the bottom of the garden that she spoke again. โI understand that you desire to ask me some question about John Maitland, of Market Milcaster?โ she said. โBefore you put it. I must ask you a question. Do you wish any reply I may give you for publication?โ โNot without your permission,โ replied Spargo. โI should not think of publishing anything you may tell me except with your express permission.โ She looked at him gloomily, seemed to gather an impression of his good faith, and nodded her head. โIn that case,โ she said, โwhat do you want to ask?โ โI have lately had reason for making certain enquiries about John Maitland,โ answered Spargo. โI suppose you read the newspapers and possibly the _Watchman_, Miss Baylis?โ But Miss Baylis shook her head. โI read no newspapers,โ she said. โI have no interest in the affairs of the world. I have work which occupies all my time: I give my whole devotion to it.โ โThen you have not recently heard of what is known as the Marbury caseโa case of a man who was found murdered?โ asked Spargo. โI have not,โ she answered. โI am not likely to hear such things.โ Spargo suddenly realized that the power of the Press is not quite as great nor as far-reaching as very young journalists hold it to be, and that there actually are, even in London, people who can live quite cheerfully without a newspaper. He concealed his astonishment and went on. โWell,โ he said, โI believe that the murdered man, known to the police as John Marbury, was, in reality, your brother-in-law, John Maitland. In fact, Miss Baylis, Iโm absolutely certain of it!โ He made this declaration with some emphasis, and looked at his stern companion to see how she was impressed. But Miss Baylis showed no sign of being impressed. โI can quite believe that, Mr. Spargo,โ she said coldly. โIt is no surprise to me that John Maitland should come to such an end. He was a thoroughly bad and unprincipled man, who brought the most terrible disgrace on those who were, unfortunately, connected with him. He was likely to die a bad manโs death.โ โI may ask you a few questions about him?โ suggested Spargo in his most insinuating manner. โYou may, so long as you do not drag my name into the papers,โ she replied. โBut pray, how do you know that I have the sad shame of being John Maitlandโs sister-in-law?โ โI found that out at Market Milcaster,โ said Spargo. โThe photographer told meโCooper.โ โAh!โ she exclaimed. โThe questions I want to ask are very simple,โ said Spargo. โBut your answers may materially help me. You remember Maitland going to prison, of course?โ Miss Baylis laughedโa laugh of scorn. โCould I ever forget it?โ she exclaimed. โDid you ever visit him in prison?โ asked Spargo. โVisit him in prison!โ she said indignantly. โVisits in prison are to be paid to those who deserve them, who are repentant; not to scoundrels who are hardened in their sin!โ โAll right. Did you ever see him after he left prison?โ โI saw him, for he forced himself upon meโI could not help myself. He was in my presence before I was aware that he had even been released.โ โWhat did he come for?โ asked Spargo. โTo ask for his sonโwho had been in my charge,โ she replied. โThatโs a thing I want to know about,โ said Spargo. โDo you know what a certain lot of people in Market Milcaster say to this day, Miss Baylis?โthey say that you were in at the game with Maitland; that you had a lot of the money placed in your charge; that when Maitland went to prison, you took the child away, first to Brighton, then abroadโdisappeared with himโand that you made a home ready for Maitland when he came out. Thatโs whatโs said by some people in Market Milcaster.โ Miss Baylisโs stern lips curled. โPeople in Market Milcaster!โ she exclaimed. โAll the people I ever knew in Market Milcaster had about as many brains between them as that cat on the wall there. As for making a home for John Maitland, I would have seen him die in the gutter, of absolute want, before I would have given him a crust of dry bread!โ โYou appear to have a terrible dislike of this man,โ observed Spargo, astonished at her vehemence. โI hadโand I have,โ she answered. โHe tricked my sister into a marriage with him when he knew that she would rather have married an honest man who worshipped her; he treated her with quiet, infernal cruelty; he robbed her and me of the small fortunes our father left us.โ โAh!โ said Spargo. โWell, so you say Maitland came to you, when he came out of prison, to ask for his boy. Did he take the boy?โ โNoโthe boy was dead.โ โDead, eh? Then I suppose Maitland did not stop long with you?โ Miss Baylis laughed her scornful laugh. โI showed him the door!โ she said. โWell, did he tell you that he was going to Australia?โ enquired Spargo. โI should not have listened to anything that he told me, Mr. Spargo,โ she answered. โThen, in short,โ said Spargo, โyou never heard of him again?โ โI never heard of him again,โ she declared passionately, โand I only hope that what you tell me is true, and that Marbury really was Maitland!โ Chapter 24 – Mother Gutch. Spargo, having exhausted the list of questions which he had thought out on his way to Bayswater, was about to take his leave of Miss Baylis, when a new idea suddenly occurred to him, and he turned back to that formidable lady. โIโve just thought of something else,โ he said. โI told you that Iโm certain Marbury was Maitland, and that he came to a sad endโmurdered.โ โAnd Iโve told you,โ she replied scornfully, โthat in my opinion no end could be too bad for him.โ โJust soโI understand you,โ said Spargo. โBut I didnโt tell you that he was not only murdered but robbedโrobbed of probably a good deal. Thereโs good reason to believe that he had securities, bank notes, loose diamonds, and other things on him to the value of a large amount. Heโd several thousand pounds when he left Coolumbidgee, in New South Wales, where heโd lived quietly for some years.โ Miss Baylis smiled sourly. โWhatโs all this to me?โ she asked. โPossibly nothing. But you see, that money, those securities, may be recovered. And as the boy you speak of is dead, there surely must be somebody whoโs entitled to the lot. Itโs worth having, Miss Baylis, and thereโs strong belief on the part of the police that it will turn up.โ This was a bit of ingenious bluff on the part of Spargo; he watched its effect with keen eyes. But Miss Baylis was adamant, and she looked as scornful as ever. โI say again whatโs all that to me?โ she exclaimed. โWell, but hadnโt the dead boy any relatives on his fatherโs side?โ asked Spargo. โI know youโre his aunt on the motherโs side, and as youโre indifferent perhaps, I can find some on the other side. Itโs very easy to find all these things out, you know.โ Miss Baylis, who had begun to stalk back to the house in gloomy and majestic fashion, and had let Spargo see plainly that this part of the interview was distasteful to her, suddenly paused in her stride and glared at the young journalist. โEasy to find all these things out?โ she repeated. Spargo caught, or fancied he caught, a note of anxiety in her tone. He was quick to turn his fancy to practical purpose. โOh, easy enough!โ he said. โI could find out all about Maitlandโs family through that boy. Quite, quite easily!โ Miss Baylis had stopped now, and stood glaring at him. โHow?โ she demanded. โIโll tell you,โ said Spargo with cheerful alacrity. โIt is, of course, the easiest thing in the world to trace all about his short life. I suppose I can find the register of his birth at Market Milcaster, and you, of course, will tell me where he died. By the by, when did he die, Miss Baylis?โ But Miss Baylis was going on again to the house. โI shall tell you nothing more,โ she said angrily. โIโve told you too much already, and I believe all youโre here for is to get some news for your paper. But I will, at any rate tell you thisโwhen Maitland went to prison his child would have been defenceless but for me; heโd have had to go to the workhouse but for me; he hadnโt a single relation in the world but me, on either fatherโs or motherโs side. And even at my age, old woman as I am, Iโd rather beg my bread in the street, Iโd rather starve and die, than touch a penny piece that had come from John Maitland! Thatโs all.โ Then without further word, without offering to show Spargo the way out, she marched in at the open window and disappeared. And Spargo, knowing no other way, was about to follow her when he heard a sudden rustling sound in the shadow by which they had stood, and the next moment a queer, cracked, horrible voice, suggesting all sorts of things, said distinctly and yet in a whisper: โYoung man!โ Spargo turned and stared at the privet hedge behind him. It was thick and bushy, and in its full summer green, but it seemed to him that he saw a nondescript shape behind. โWhoโs there?โ he demanded. โSomebody listening?โ There was a curious cackle of laughter from behind the hedge; then the cracked, husky voice spoke again. โYoung man, donโt you move or look as if you were talking to anybody. Do you know where the โKing of Madagascarโ public-house is in this quarter of the town, young man?โ โNo!โ answered Spargo. โCertainly not!โ โWell, anybodyโll tell you when you get outside, young man,โ continued the queer voice of the unseen person. โGo there, and wait at the corner by the โKing of Madagascar,โ and Iโll come there to you at the end of half an hour. Then Iโll tell you something, young manโIโll tell you something. Now run away, young man, run away to the โKing of MadagascarโโIโm coming!โ The voice ended in low, horrible cachinnation which made Spargo feel queer. But he was young enough to be in love with adventure, and he immediately turned on his heel without so much as a glance at the privet hedge, and went across the garden and through the house, and let himself out at the door. And at the next corner of the square he met a policeman and asked him if he knew where the โKing of Madagascarโ was. โFirst to the right, second to the left,โ answered the policeman tersely. โYou canโt miss it anywhere round thereโitโs a landmark.โ And Spargo found the landmarkโa great, square-built tavernโeasily, and he waited at a corner of it wondering what he was going to see, and intensely curious about the owner of the queer voice, with all its suggestions of he knew not what. And suddenly there came up to him an old woman and leered at him in a fashion that made him suddenly realize how dreadful old age may be. Spargo had never seen such an old woman as this in his life. She was dressed respectably, better than respectably. Her gown was good; her bonnet was smart; her smaller fittings were good. But her face was evil; it showed unmistakable signs of a long devotion to the bottle; the old eyes leered and ogled, the old lips were wicked. Spargo felt a sense of disgust almost amounting to nausea, but he was going to hear what the old harridan had to say and he tried not to look what he felt. โWell?โ he said, almost roughly. โWell?โ โWell, young man, there you are,โ said his new acquaintance. โLet us go inside, young man; thereโs a quiet little place where a lady can sit and take her drop of ginโIโll show you. And if youโre good to me, Iโll tell you something about that cat that you were talking to just now. But youโll give me a little matter to put in my pocket, young man? Old ladies like me have a right to buy little comforts, you know, little comforts.โ Spargo followed this extraordinary person into a small parlour within; the attendant who came in response to a ring showed no astonishment at her presence; he also seemed to know exactly what she required, which was a certain brand of gin, sweetened, and warm. And Spargo watched her curiously as with shaking hand she pushed up the veil which hid little of her wicked old face, and lifted the glass to her mouth with a zest which was not thirst but pure greed of liquor. Almost instantly he saw a new light steal into her eyes, and she laughed in a voice that grew clearer with every sound she made. โAh, young man!โ she said with a confidential nudge of the elbow that made Spargo long to get up and fly. โI wanted that! Itโs done me good. When Iโve finished that, youโll pay for another for meโand perhaps another? Theyโll do me still more good. And youโll give me a little matter of money, wonโt you, young man?โ โNot till I know what Iโm giving it for,โ replied Spargo. โYouโll be giving it because Iโm going to tell you that if itโs made worth my while I can tell you, or somebody that sent you, more about Jane Baylis than anybody in the world. Iโm not going to tell you that now, young manโIโm sure you donโt carry in your pocket what I shall want for my secret, not you, by the look of you! Iโm only going to show you that I have the secret. Eh?โ โWho are you?โ asked Spargo. The woman leered and chuckled. โWhat are you going to give me, young man?โ she asked. Spargo put his fingers in his pocket and pulled out two half-sovereigns. โLook here,โ he said, showing his companion the coins, โif you can tell me anything of importance you shall have these. But no trifling, now. And no wasting of time. If you have anything to tell, out with it!โ The woman stretched out a trembling, claw-like hand. โBut let me hold one of those, young man!โ she implored. โLet me hold one of the beautiful bits of gold. I shall tell you all the better if I hold one of them. Let meโthereโs a good young gentleman.โ Spargo gave her one of the coins, and resigned himself to his fate, whatever it might be. โYou wonโt get the other unless you tell something,โ he said. โWho are you, anyway?โ The woman, who had begun mumbling and chuckling over the half-sovereign, grinned horribly. โAt the boarding-house yonder, young man, they call me Mother Gutch,โ she answered; โbut my proper name is Mrs. Sabina Gutch, and once upon a time I was a good-looking young woman. And when my husband died I went to Jane Baylis as housekeeper, and when she retired from that and came to live in that boarding-house where we live now, she was forced to bring me with her and to keep me. Why had she to do that, young man?โ โHeaven knows!โ answered Spargo. โBecause Iโve got a hold on her, young manโIโve got a secret of hers,โ continued Mother Gutch. โSheโd be scared to death if she knew Iโd been behind that hedge and had heard what she said to you, and sheโd be more than scared if she knew that you and I were here, talking. But sheโs grown hard and near with me, and she wonโt give me a penny to get a drop of anything with, and an old woman like me has a right to her little comforts, and if youโll buy the secret, young man, Iโll split on her, there and then, when you pay the money.โ โBefore I talk about buying any secret,โ said Spargo, โyouโll have to prove to me that youโve a secret to sell thatโs worth my buying.โ โAnd I will prove it!โ said Mother Gutch with sudden fierceness. โTouch the bell, and let me have another glass, and then Iโll tell you. Now,โ she went on, more quietlyโSpargo noticed that the more she drank, the more rational she became, and that her nerves seemed to gain strength and her whole appearance to be improvedโโnow, you came to her to find out about her brother-in-law, Maitland, that went to prison, didnโt you?โ โWell?โ demanded Spargo. โAnd about that boy of his?โ she continued. โYou heard all that was said,โ answered Spargo. โIโm waiting to hear what you have to say.โ But Mother Gutch was resolute in having her own way. She continued her questions: โAnd she told you that Maitland came and asked for the boy, and that she told him the boy was dead, didnโt she?โ she went on. โWell?โ said Spargo despairingly. โShe did. What then?โ Mother Gutch took an appreciative pull at her glass and smiled knowingly. โWhat then?โ she chuckled. โAll lies, young man, the boy isnโt deadโany more than I am. And my secret isโโ โWell?โ demanded Spargo impatiently. โWhat is it?โ โThis!โ answered Mother Gutch, digging her companion in the ribs, โI know what she did with him!โ Chapter 25 – Revelations. Spargo turned on his disreputable and dissolute companion with all his journalistic energies and instincts roused. He had not been sure, since entering the โKing of Madagascar,โ that he was going to hear anything material to the Middle Temple Murder; he had more than once feared that this old gin-drinking harridan was deceiving him, for the purpose of extracting drink and money from him. But now, at the mere prospect of getting important information from her, he forgot all about Mother Gutchโs unfortunate propensities, evil eyes, and sodden face; he only saw in her somebody who could tell him something. He turned on her eagerly. โYou say that John Maitlandโs son didnโt die!โ he exclaimed. โThe boy did not die,โ replied Mother Gutch. โAnd that you know where he is?โ asked Spargo. Mother Gutch shook her head. โI didnโt say that I know where he is, young man,โ she replied. โI said I knew what she did with him.โ โWhat, then?โ demanded Spargo. Mother Gutch drew herself up in a vast assumption of dignity, and favoured Spargo with a look. โThatโs the secret, young man,โ she said. โIโm willing to sell that secret, but not for two half-sovereigns and two or three drops of cold gin. If Maitland left all that money you told Jane Baylis of, when I was listening to you from behind the hedge, my secretโs worth something.โ Spargo suddenly remembered his bit of bluff to Miss Baylis. Here was an unexpected result of it. โNobody but me can help you to trace Maitlandโs boy,โ continued Mother Gutch, โand I shall expect to be paid accordingly. Thatโs plain language, young man.โ Spargo considered the situation in silence for a minute or two. Could this wretched, bibulous old woman really be in possession of a secret which would lead to the solving of the mystery of the Middle Temple Murder? Well, it would be a fine thing for the _Watchman_ if the clearing up of everything came through one of its men. And the _Watchman_ was noted for being generous even to extravagance in laying out money on all sorts of objects: it had spent money like water on much less serious matters than this. โHow much do you want for your secret?โ he suddenly asked, turning to his companion. Mother Gutch began to smooth out a pleat in her gown. It was really wonderful to Spargo to find how very sober and normal this old harridan had become; he did not understand that her nerves had been all a-quiver and on edge when he first met her, and that a resort to her favourite form of alcohol in liberal quantity had calmed and quickened them; secretly he was regarding her with astonishment as the most extraordinary old person he had ever met, and he was almost afraid of her as he waited for her decision. At last Mother Gutch spoke. โWell, young man,โ she said, โhaving considered matters, and having a right to look well to myself, I think that what I should prefer to have would be one of those annuities. A nice, comfortable annuity, paid weeklyโnone of your monthlies or quarterlies, but regular and punctual, every Saturday morning. Or Monday morning, as was convenient to the parties concernedโbut punctual and regular. I know a good many ladies in my sphere of life as enjoys annuities, and itโs a great comfort to have ’em paid weekly.โ It occurred to Spargo that Mrs. Gutch would probably get rid of her weekly dole on the day it was paid, whether that day happened to be Monday or Saturday, but that, after all, was no concern of his, so he came back to first principles. โEven now you havenโt said how much,โ he remarked. โThree pound a week,โ replied Mother Gutch. โAnd cheap, too!โ Spargo thought hard for two minutes. The secret mightโmight!โlead to something big. This wretched old woman would probably drink herself to death within a year or two. Anyhow, a few hundreds of pounds was nothing to the _Watchman_. He glanced at his watch. At that hourโfor the next hourโthe great man of the _Watchman_ would be at the office. He jumped to his feet, suddenly resolved and alert. โHere, Iโll take you to see my principals,โ he said. โWeโll run along in a taxi-cab.โ โWith all the pleasure in the world, young man,โ replied Mother Gutch; โwhen youโve given me that other half-sovereign. As for principals, Iโd far rather talk business with masters than with menโthough I mean no disrespect to you.โ Spargo, feeling that he was in for it, handed over the second half-sovereign, and busied himself in ordering a taxi-cab. But when that came round he had to wait while Mrs. Gutch consumed a third glass of gin and purchased a flask of the same beverage to put in her pocket. At last he got her off, and in due course to the _Watchman_ office, where the hall-porter and the messenger boys stared at her in amazement, well used as they were to seeing strange folk, and he got her to his own room, and locked her in, and then he sought the presence of the mighty. What Spargo said to his editor and to the great man who controlled the fortunes and workings of the _Watchman_ he never knew. It was probably fortunate for him that they were both thoroughly conversant with the facts of the Middle Temple Murder, and saw that there might be an advantage in securing the revelations of which Spargo had got the conditional promise. At any rate, they accompanied Spargo to his room, intent on seeing, hearing and bargaining with the lady he had locked up there. Spargoโs room smelt heavily of unsweetened gin, but Mother Gutch was soberer than ever. She insisted upon being introduced to proprietor and editor in due and proper form, and in discussing terms with them before going into any further particulars. The editor was all for temporizing with her until something could be done to find out what likelihood of truth there was in her, but the proprietor, after sizing her up in his own shrewd fashion, took his two companions out of the room. โWeโll hear what the old woman has to say on her own terms,โ he said. โShe may have something to tell that is really of the greatest importance in this case: she certainly has something to tell. And, as Spargo says, sheโll probably drink herself to death in about as short a time as possible. Come backโletโs hear her story.โ So they returned to the gin-scented atmosphere, and a formal document was drawn out by which the proprietor of the _Watchman_ bound himself to pay Mrs. Gutch the sum of three pounds a week for life (Mrs. Gutch insisting on the insertion of the words โevery Saturday morning, punctual and regularโ) and then Mrs. Gutch was invited to tell her tale. And Mrs. Gutch settled herself to do so, and Spargo prepared to take it down, word for word. โWhich the story, as that young man called it, is not so long as a monkeyโs tail nor so short as a Manx catโs, gentlemen,โ said Mrs. Gutch; โbut full of meat as an egg. Now, you see, when that Maitland affair at Market Milcaster came off, I was housekeeper to Miss Jane Baylis at Brighton. She kept a boarding-house there, in Kemp Town, and close to the sea-front, and a very good thing she made out of it, and had saved a nice bit, and having, like her sister, Mrs. Maitland, had a little fortune left her by her father, as was at one time a publican here in London, she had a good lump of money. And all that money was in this here Maitlandโs hands, every penny. I very well remember the day when the news came about that affair of Maitland robbing the bank. Miss Baylis, she was like a mad thing when she saw it in the paper, and before sheโd seen it an hour she was off to Market Milcaster. I went up to the station with her, and she told me then before she got in the train that Maitland had all her fortune and her savings, and her sisterโs, his wifeโs, too, and that she feared all would be lost.โ โMrs. Maitland was then dead,โ observed Spargo without looking up from his writing-block. โShe was, young man, and a good thing, too,โ continued Mrs. Gutch. โWell, away went Miss Baylis, and no more did I hear or see for nearly a week, and then back she comes, and brings a little boy with herโwhich was Maitlandโs. And she told me that night that sheโd lost every penny she had in the world, and that her sisterโs money, what ought to have been the childโs, was gone, too, and she said her say about Maitland. However, she saw well to that child; nobody could have seen better. And very soon after, when Maitland was sent to prison for ten years, her and me talked about things. โWhatโs the use,โ says I to her, โof your letting yourself get so fond of that child, and looking after it as you do, and educating it, and so on?โ I says. โWhy not?โ says she. โโTisnโt yours,โ I says, โyou havenโt no right to it,โ I says. โAs soon as ever its father comes out,โ says I,โ heโll come and claim it, and you canโt do nothing to stop him.โ Well, gentlemen, if youโll believe me, never did I see a woman look as she did when I says all that. And she up and swore that Maitland should never see or touch the child againโnot under no circumstances whatever.โ Mrs. Gutch paused to take a little refreshment from her pocket-flask, with an apologetic remark as to the state of her heart. She resumed, presently, apparently refreshed. โWell, gentlemen, that notion, about Maitlandโs taking the child away from her seemed to get on her mind, and she used to talk to me at times about it, always saying the same thingโthat Maitland should never have him. And one day she told me she was going to London to see lawyers about it, and she went, and she came back, seeming more satisfied, and a day or two afterwards, there came a gentleman who looked like a lawyer, and he stopped a day or two, and he came again and again, until one day she came to me, and she says, โYou donโt know who that gentleman is thatโs come so much lately?โ she says. โNot I,โ I says, โunless heโs after you.โ โAfter me!โ she says, tossing her head: โThatโs the gentleman that ought to have married my poor sister if that scoundrel Maitland hadnโt tricked her into throwing him over!โ โYou donโt say so!โ I says. โThen by rights he ought to have been the childโs pa!โ โHeโs going to be a father to the boy,โ she says. โHeโs going to take him and educate him in the highest fashion, and make a gentleman of him,โ she says, โfor his motherโs sake.โ โMercy on us!โ says I. โWhatโll Maitland say when he comes for him?โ โMaitlandโll never come for him,โ she says, โfor Iโm going to leave here, and the boyโll be gone before then. This is all being done,โ she says, โso that the childโll never know his fatherโs shameโheโll never know who his father was.โ And true enough, the boy was taken away, but Maitland came before sheโd gone, and she told him the child was dead, and I never see a man so cut up. However, it wasnโt no concern of mine. And so thereโs so much of the secret, gentlemen, and I would like to know if I ainโt giving good value.โ โVery good,โ said the proprietor. โGo on.โ But Spargo intervened. โDid you ever hear the name of the gentleman who took the boy away?โ he asked. โYes, I did,โ replied Mrs. Gutch. โOf course I did. Which it was Elphick.โ Chapter 26 – Still Silent. Spargo dropped his pen on the desk before him with a sharp clatter that made Mrs. Gutch jump. A steady devotion to the bottle had made her nerves to be none of the strongest, and she looked at the startler of them with angry malevolence. โDonโt do that again, young man!โ she exclaimed sharply. โI canโt a-bear to be jumped out of my skin, and itโs bad manners. I observed that the gentlemanโs name was Elphick.โ Spargo contrived to get in a glance at his proprietor and his editorโa glance which came near to being a wink. โJust soโElphick,โ he said. โA law gentleman I think you said, Mrs. Gutch?โ โI said,โ answered Mrs. Gutch, โas how he looked like a lawyer gentleman. And since youโre so particular, young man, though I wasnโt addressing you but your principals, he was a lawyer gentleman. One of the sort that wears wigs and gownsโainโt I seen his picture in Jane Baylisโs room at the boarding-house where you saw her this morning?โ โElderly man?โ asked Spargo. โElderly he will be now,โ replied the informant; โbut when he took the boy away he was a middle-aged man. About his age,โ she added, pointing to the editor in a fashion which made that worthy man wince and the proprietor desire to laugh unconsumedly; โand not so very unlike him neither, being one as had no hair on his face.โ โAh!โ said Spargo. โAnd where did this Mr. Elphick take the boy, Mrs. Gutch?โ But Mrs. Gutch shook her head. โAinโt no idea,โ she said. โHe took him. Then, as I told you, Maitland came, and Jane Baylis told him that the boy was dead. And after that she never even told me anything about the boy. She kept a tight tongue. Once or twice I asked her, and she says, โNever you mind,โ she says; โheโs all right for life, if he lives to be as old as Methusalem.โ And she never said more, and I never said more. But,โ continued Mrs. Gutch, whose pocket-flask was empty, and who began to wipe tears away, โsheโs treated me hard has Jane Baylis, never allowing me a little comfort such as a lady of my age should have, and when I hears the two of you a-talking this morning the other side of that privet hedge, thinks I, โNowโs the time to have my knife into you, my fine madam!โ And I hope I done it.โ Spargo looked at the editor and the proprietor, nodding his head slightly. He meant them to understand that he had got all he wanted from Mother Gutch. โWhat are you going to do, Mrs. Gutch, when you leave here?โ he asked. โYou shall be driven straight back to Bayswater, if you like. โWhich I shall be obliged for, young man,โ said Mrs. Gutch, โand likewise for the first week of the annuity, and will call every Saturday for the same at eleven punctual, or can be posted to me on a Friday, whichever is agreeable to you gentlemen. And having my first week in my purse, and being driven to Bayswater, I shall take my boxes and go to a friend of mine where I shall be hearty welcome, shaking the dust of my feet off against Jane Baylis and where Iโve been living with her.โ โYes, but, Mrs. Gutch,โ said Spargo, with some anxiety, โif you go back there tonight, youโll be very careful not to tell Miss Baylis that youโve been here and told us all this?โ Mrs. Gutch rose, dignified and composed. โYoung man,โ she said, โyou mean well, but you ainโt used to dealing with ladies. I can keep my tongue as still as anybody when I like. I wouldnโt tell Jane Baylis my affairsโmy new affairs, gentlemen, thanks to youโnot for two annuities, paid twice a week!โ โTake Mrs. Gutch downstairs, Spargo, and see her all right, and then come to my room,โ said the editor. โAnd donโt you forget, Mrs. Gutchโkeep a quiet tongue in your headโno more talkโor thereโll be no annuities on Saturday mornings.โ So Spargo took Mother Gutch to the cashierโs department and paid her her first weekโs money, and he got her a taxi-cab, and paid for it, and saw her depart, and then he went to the editorโs room, strangely thoughtful. The editor and the proprietor were talking, but they stopped when Spargo entered and looked at him eagerly. โI think weโve done it,โ said Spargo quietly. โWhat, precisely, have we found out?โ asked the editor. โA great deal more than Iโd anticipated,โ answered Spargo, โand I donโt know what fields it doesnโt open out. If you look back, youโll remember that the only thing found on Marburyโs body was a scrap of grey paper on which was a name and addressโRonald Breton, Kingโs Bench Walk.โ โWell?โ โBreton is a young barrister. Also he writes a bitโI have accepted two or three articles of his for our literary page.โ โWell?โ โFurther, he is engaged to Miss Aylmore, the eldest daughter of Aylmore, the Member of Parliament who has been charged at Bow Street today with the murder of Marbury.โ โI know. Well, what then, Spargo?โ โBut the most important matter,โ continued Spargo, speaking very deliberately, โis thisโthat is, taking that old womanโs statement to be true, as I personally believe it isโthat Breton, as he has told me himself (I have seen a good deal of him) was brought up by a guardian. That guardian is Mr. Septimus Elphick, the barrister. โ The proprietor and the editor looked at each other. Their faces wore the expression of men thinking on the same lines and arriving at the same conclusion. And the proprietor suddenly turned on Spargo with a sharp interrogation: โYou think thenโโโ Spargo nodded. โI think that Mr. Septimus Elphick is the Elphick, and that Breton is the young Maitland of whom Mrs. Gutch has been talking,โ he answered. The editor got up, thrust his hands in his pockets, and began to pace the room. โIf thatโs so,โ he said, โif thatโs so, the mystery deepens. What do you propose to do, Spargo?โ โI think,โ said Spargo, slowly, โI think that without telling him anything of what we have learnt, I should like to see young Breton and get an introduction from him to Mr. Elphick. I can make a good excuse for wanting an interview with him. If you will leave it in my handsโโ โYes, yes!โ said the proprietor, waving a hand. โLeave it entirely in Spargoโs hands.โ โKeep me informed,โ said the editor. โDo what you think. It strikes me youโre on the track.โ Spargo left their presence, and going back to his own room, still faintly redolent of the personality of Mrs. Gutch, got hold of the reporter who had been present at Bow Street when Aylmore was brought up that morning. There was nothing new; the authorities had merely asked for another remand. So far as the reporter knew, Aylmore had said nothing fresh to anybody. Spargo went round to the Temple and up to Ronald Bretonโs chambers. He found the young barrister just preparing to leave, and looking unusually grave and thoughtful. At sight of Spargo he turned back from his outer door, beckoned the journalist to follow him, and led him into an inner room. โI say, Spargo!โ he said, as he motioned his visitor to take a chair. โThis is becoming something more than serious. You know what you told me to do yesterday as regards Aylmore?โ โTo get him to tell all?โYes,โ said Spargo. Breton shook his head. โStrattonโhis solicitor, you knowโand I saw him this morning before the police-court proceedings,โ he continued. โI told him of my talk with you; I even went as far as to tell him that his daughters had been to the _Watchman_ office. Stratton and I both begged him to take your advice and tell all, everything, no matter at what cost to his private feelings. We pointed out to him the serious nature of the evidence against him; how he had damaged himself by not telling the whole truth at once; how he had certainly done a great deal to excite suspicion against himself; how, as the evidence stands at present, any jury could scarcely do less than convict him. And it was all no good, Spargo!โ โHe wonโt say anything?โ โHeโll say no more. He was adamant. โI told the entire truth in respect to my dealings with Marbury on the night he met his death at the inquest,โ he said, over and over again, โand I shall say nothing further on any consideration. If the law likes to hang an innocent man on such evidence as that, let it!โ And he persisted in that until we left him. Spargo, I donโt know whatโs to be done.โ โAnd nothing happened at the police-court?โ โNothingโanother remand. Stratton and I saw Aylmore again before he was removed. He left us with a sort of sardonic remarkโโIf you all want to prove me innocent,โ he said, โfind the guilty man.โโ โWell, there was a tremendous lot of common sense in that,โ said Spargo. โYes, of course, but how, how, how is it going to be done?โ exclaimed Breton. โAre you any nearerโis Rathbury any nearer? Is there the slightest clue that will fasten the guilt on anybody else?โ Spargo gave no answer to these questions. He remained silent a while, apparently thinking. โWas Rathbury in court?โ he suddenly asked. โHe was,โ replied Breton. โHe was there with two or three other men who I suppose were detectives, and seemed to be greatly interested in Aylmore.โ โIf I donโt see Rathbury tonight Iโll see him in the morning,โ said Spargo. He rose as if to go, but after lingering a moment, sat down again. โLook here,โ he continued, โI donโt know how this thing stands in law, but would it be a very weak case against Aylmore if the prosecution couldnโt show some motive for his killing Marbury?โ Breton smiled. โThereโs no necessity to prove motive in murder,โ he said. โBut Iโll tell you what, Spargoโif the prosecution can show that Aylmore had a motive for getting rid of Marbury, if they could prove that it was to Aylmoreโs advantage to silence himโwhy, then, I donโt think heโs a chance.โ โI see. But so far no motive, no reason for his killing Marbury has been shown.โ โI know of none.โ Spargo rose and moved to the door. โWell, Iโm off,โ he said. Then, as if he suddenly recollected something, he turned back. โOh, by the by,โ he said, โisnโt your guardian, Mr. Elphick, a big authority on philately?โ โOne of the biggest. Awful enthusiast. โDo you think heโd tell me a bit about those Australian stamps which Marbury showed to Criedir, the dealer?โ โCertain, he wouldโdelighted. Hereโโand Breton scribbled a few words on a cardโโthereโs his address and a word from me. Iโll tell you when you can always find him in, five nights out of sevenโat nine oโclock, after heโs dined. Iโd go with you tonight, but I must go to Aylmoreโs. The two girls are in terrible trouble.โ โGive them a message from me,โ said Spargo as they went out together. โTell them to keep up their hearts and their courage.โ Chapter 27 – Mr. Elphick’s Chambers. Spargo went round again to the Temple that night at nine oโclock, asking himself over and over again two questionsโthe first, how much does Elphick know? the second, how much shall I tell him? The old house in the Temple to which he repaired and in which many a generation of old fogies had lived since the days of Queen Anne, was full of stairs and passages, and as Spargo had forgotten to get the exact number of the set of chambers he wanted, he was obliged to wander about in what was a deserted building. So wandering, he suddenly heard steps, firm, decisive steps coming up a staircase which he himself had just climbed. He looked over the banisters down into the hollow beneath. And there, marching up resolutely, was the figure of a tall, veiled woman, and Spargo suddenly realized, with a sharp quickening of his pulses, that for the second time that day he was beneath one roof with Miss Baylis. Spargoโs mind acted quickly. Knowing what he now knew, from his extraordinary dealings with Mother Gutch, he had no doubt whatever that Miss Baylis had come to see Mr. Elphickโcome, of course, to tell Mr. Elphick that he, Spargo, had visited her that morning, and that he was on the track of the Maitland secret history. He had never thought of it before, for he had been busily engaged since the departure of Mother Gutch; but, naturally, Miss Baylis and Mr. Elphick would keep in communication with each other. At any rate, here she was, and her destination was, surely, Elphickโs chambers. And the question for him, Spargo, wasโwhat to do? What Spargo did was to remain in absolute silence, motionless, tense, where he was on the stair, and to trust to the chance that the woman did not look up. But Miss Baylis neither looked up nor down: she reached a landing, turned along a corridor with decision, and marched forward. A moment later Spargo heard a sharp double knock on a door: a moment after that he heard a door heavily shut; he knew then that Miss Baylis had sought and gained admittanceโsomewhere. To find out precisely where that somewhere was drew Spargo down to the landing which Miss Baylis had just left. There was no one aboutโhe had not, in fact, seen a soul since he entered the building. Accordingly he went along the corridor into which he had seen Miss Baylis turn. He knew that all the doors in that house were double ones, and that the outer oak in each was solid and substantial enough to be sound proof. Yet, as men will under such circumstances, he walked softly; he said to himself, smiling at the thought, that he would be sure to start if somebody suddenly opened a door on him. But no hand opened any door, and at last he came to the end of the corridor and found himself confronting a small board on which was painted in white letters on a black ground, Mr. Elphickโs Chambers. Having satisfied himself as to his exact whereabouts, Spargo drew back as quietly as he had come. There was a window half-way along the corridor from which, he had noticed as he came along, one could catch a glimpse of the Embankment and the Thames; to this he withdrew, and leaning on the sill looked out and considered matters. Should he go andโif he could gain admittanceโbeard these two conspirators? Should he wait until the woman came out and let her see that he was on the track? Should he hide again until she went, and then see Elphick alone? In the end Spargo did none of these things immediately. He let things slide for the moment. He lighted a cigarette and stared at the river and the brown sails, and the buildings across on the Surrey side. Ten minutes went byโtwenty minutesโnothing happened. Then, as half-past nine struck from all the neighbouring clocks, Spargo flung away a second cigarette, marched straight down the corridor and knocked boldly at Mr. Elphickโs door. Greatly to Spargoโs surprise, the door was opened before there was any necessity to knock again. And there, calmly confronting him, a benevolent, yet somewhat deprecating expression on his spectacled and placid face, stood Mr. Elphick, a smoking cap on his head, a tasseled smoking jacket over his dress shirt, and a short pipe in his hand. Spargo was taken aback: Mr. Elphick apparently was not. He held the door well open, and motioned the journalist to enter. โCome in, Mr. Spargo,โ he said. โI was expecting you. Walk forward into my sitting-room. โ Spargo, much astonished at this reception, passed through an ante-room into a handsomely furnished apartment full of books and pictures. In spite of the fact that it was still very little past midsummer there was a cheery fire in the grate, and on a table set near a roomy arm-chair was set such creature comforts as a spirit-case, a syphon, a tumbler, and a novelโfrom which things Spargo argued that Mr. Elphick had been taking his ease since his dinner. But in another armchair on the opposite side of the hearth was the forbidding figure of Miss Baylis, blacker, gloomier, more mysterious than ever. She neither spoke nor moved when Spargo entered: she did not even look at him. And Spargo stood staring at her until Mr. Elphick, having closed his doors, touched him on the elbow, and motioned him courteously to a seat. โYes, I was expecting you, Mr. Spargo,โ he said, as he resumed his own chair. โI have been expecting you at any time, ever since you took up your investigation of the Marbury affair, in some of the earlier stages of which you saw me, you will remember, at the mortuary. But since Miss Baylis told me, twenty minutes ago, that you had been to her this morning I felt sure that it would not be more than a few hours before you would come to me.โ โWhy, Mr. Elphick, should you suppose that I should come to you at all?โ asked Spargo, now in full possession of his wits. โBecause I felt sure that you would leave no stone unturned, no corner unexplored,โ replied Mr. Elphick. โThe curiosity of the modern pressman is insatiable.โ Spargo stiffened. โI have no curiosity, Mr. Elphick,โ he said. โI am charged by my paper to investigate the circumstances of the death of the man who was found in Middle Temple Lane, and, if possible, to track his murderer, andโโโ Mr. Elphick laughed slightly and waved his hand. โMy good young gentleman!โ he said. โYou exaggerate your own importance. I donโt approve of modern journalism nor of its methods. In your own case you have got hold of some absurd notion that the man John Marbury was in reality one John Maitland, once of Market Milcaster, and you have been trying to frighten Miss Baylis here intoโโโ Spargo suddenly rose from his chair. There was a certain temper in him which, when once roused, led him to straight hitting, and it was roused now. He looked the old barrister full in the face. โMr. Elphick,โ he said, โyou are evidently unaware of all that I know. So I will tell you what I will do. I will go back to my office, and I will write down what I do know, and give the true and absolute proofs of what I know, and, if you will trouble yourself to read the _Watchman_ tomorrow morning, then you, too, will know.โ โDear meโdear me!โ said Mr. Elphick, banteringly. โWe are so used to ultra-sensational stories from the _Watchman_ thatโbut I am a curious and inquisitive old man, my good young sir, so perhaps you will tell me in a word what it is you do know, eh?โ Spargo reflected for a second. Then he bent forward across the table and looked the old barrister straight in the face. โYes,โ he said quietly. โI will tell you what I know beyond doubt. I know that the man murdered under the name of John Marbury was, without doubt, John Maitland, of Market Milcaster, and that Ronald Breton is his son, whom you took from that woman!โ If Spargo had desired a complete revenge for the cavalier fashion in which Mr. Elphick had treated it he could not have been afforded a more ample one than that offered to him by the old barristerโs reception of this news. Mr. Elphickโs face not only fell, but changed; his expression of almost sneering contempt was transformed to one clearly resembling abject terror; he dropped his pipe, fell back in his chair, recovered himself, gripped the chairโs arms, and stared at Spargo as if the young man had suddenly announced to him that in another minute he must be led to instant execution. And Spargo, quick to see his advantage, followed it up. โThat is what I know, Mr. Elphick, and if I choose, all the world shall know it tomorrow morning!โ he said firmly. โRonald Breton is the son of the murdered man, and Ronald Breton is engaged to be married to the daughter of the man charged with the murder. Do you hear that? It is not matter of suspicion, or of idea, or of conjecture, it is factโfact!โ Mr. Elphick slowly turned his face to Miss Baylis. He gasped out a few words. โYouโdidโnotโtellโmeโthis!โ Then Spargo, turning to the woman, saw that she, too, was white to the lips and as frightened as the man. โIโdidnโt know!โ she muttered. โHe didnโt tell me. He only told me this morning whatโwhat Iโve told you.โ Spargo picked up his hat. โGood-night, Mr. Elphick,โ he said. But before he could reach the door the old barrister had leapt from his chair and seized him with trembling hands. Spargo turned and looked at him. He knew then that for some reason or other he had given Mr. Septimus Elphick a thoroughly bad fright. โWell?โ he growled. โMy dear young gentleman!โ implored Mr. Elphick. โDonโt go! IโllโIโll do anything for you if you wonโt go away to print that. IโllโIโll give you a thousand pounds!โ Spargo shook him off. โThatโs enough!โ he snarled. โNow, I am off! What, youโd try to bribe me?โ Mr. Elphick wrung his hands. โI didnโt mean thatโindeed I didnโt!โ he almost wailed. โIโI donโt know what I meant. Stay, young gentleman, stay a little, and let usโlet us talk. Let me have a word with youโas many words as you please. I implore you!โ Spargo made a fine pretence of hesitation. โIf I stay,โ he said, at last, โit will only be on the strict condition that you answerโand answer trulyโwhatever questions I like to ask you. Otherwiseโโโ He made another move to the door, and again Mr. Elphick laid beseeching hands on him. โStay!โ he said. โIโll answer anything you like!โ Chapter 28 – Of Proved Identity. Spargo sat down again in the chair which he had just left, and looked at the two people upon whom his startling announcement had produced such a curious effect. And he recognized as he looked at them that, while they were both frightened, they were frightened in different ways. Miss Baylis had already recovered her composure; she now sat sombre and stern as ever, returning Spargoโs look with something of indifferent defiance; he thought he could see that in her mind a certain fear was battling with a certain amount of wonder that he had discovered the secret. It seemed to him that so far as she was concerned the secret had come to an end; it was as if she said in so many words that now the secret was out he might do his worst. But upon Mr. Septimus Elphick the effect was very different. He was still trembling from excitement; he groaned as he sank into his chair and the hand with which he poured out a glass of spirits shook; the glass rattled against his teeth when he raised it to his lips. The half-contemptuous fashion of his reception of Spargo had now wholly disappeared; he was a man who had received a shock, and a bad one. And Spargo, watching him keenly, said to himself: This man knows a great deal more than, a great deal beyond, the mere fact that Marbury was Maitland, and that Ronald Breton is in reality Maitlandโs son; he knows something which he never wanted anybody to know, which he firmly believed it impossible anybody ever could know. It was as if he had buried something deep, deep down in the lowest depths, and was as astounded as he was frightened to find that it had been at last flung up to the broad light of day. โI shall wait,โ suddenly said Spargo, โuntil you are composed, Mr. Elphick. I have no wish to distress you. But I see, of course, that the truths which I have told you are of a sort that cause you considerableโshall we say fear?โ Elphick took another stiff pull at his liquor. His hand had grown steadier, and the colour was coming back to his face. โIf you will let me explain,โ he said. โIf you will hear what was done for the boyโs sakeโeh?โ โThat,โ answered Spargo, โis precisely what I wish. I can tell you thisโI am the last man in the world to wish harm of any sort to Mr. Breton.โ Miss Baylis relieved her feelings with a scornful sniff. โHe says that!โ she exclaimed, addressing the ceiling. โHe says that, knowing that he means to tell the world in his rag of a paper that Ronald Breton, on whom every care has been lavished, is the son of a scoundrel, an ex-convict, aโโโ Elphick lifted his hand. โHushโhush!โ he said imploringly. โMr. Spargo means well, I am sureโI am convinced. If Mr. Spargo will hear meโโโ But before Spargo could reply, a loud insistent knocking came at the outer door. Elphick started nervously, but presently he moved across the room, walking as if he had received a blow, and opened the door. A boyโs voice penetrated into the sitting-room. โIf you please, sir, is Mr. Spargo, of the _Watchman_, here? He left this address in case he was wanted.โ Spargo recognized the voice as that of one of the office messenger boys, and jumping up, went to the door. โWhat is it, Rawlins?โ he asked. โWill you please come back to the office, sir, at once? Thereโs Mr. Rathbury there and says he must see you instantly.โ โAll right,โ answered Spargo. โIโm coming just now.โ He motioned the lad away, and turned to Elphick. โI shall have to go,โ he said. โI may be kept. Now, Mr. Elphick, can I come to see you tomorrow morning?โ โYes, yes, tomorrow morning!โ replied Elphick eagerly. โTomorrow morning, certainly. At elevenโeleven oโclock. That will do?โ โI shall be here at eleven,โ said Spargo. โEleven sharp.โ He was moving away when Elphick caught him by the sleeve. โA wordโjust a word!โ he said. โYouโyou have not told theโthe boyโRonaldโof what you know? You havenโt?โ โI havenโt,โ replied Spargo. Elphick tightened his grip on Spargoโs sleeve. He looked into his face beseechingly. โPromise meโpromise me, Mr. Spargo, that you wonโt tell him until you have seen me in the morning!โ he implored. โI beg you to promise me this.โ Spargo hesitated, considering matters. โVery wellโI promise,โ he said. โAnd you wonโt print it?โ continued Elphick, still clinging to him. โSay you wonโt print it tonight?โ โI shall not print it tonight,โ answered Spargo. โThatโs certain.โ Elphick released his grip on the young manโs arm. โComeโat eleven tomorrow morning,โ he said, and drew back and closed the door. Spargo ran quickly to the office and hurried up to his own room. And there, calmly seated in an easy-chair, smoking a cigar, and reading an evening newspaper, was Rathbury, unconcerned and outwardly as imperturbable as ever. He greeted Spargo with a careless nod and a smile. โWell,โ he said, โhowโs things?โ Spargo, half-breathless, dropped into his desk-chair. โYou didnโt come here to tell me that,โ he said. Rathbury laughed. โNo,โ he said, throwing the newspaper aside, โI didnโt. I came to tell you my latest. Youโre at full liberty to stick it into your paper tonight: it may just as well be known.โ โWell?โ said Spargo. Rathbury took his cigar out of his lips and yawned. โAylmoreโs identified,โ he said lazily. Spargo sat up, sharply. โIdentified!โ โIdentified, my son. Beyond doubt.โ โBut as whomโas what?โ exclaimed Spargo. Rathbury laughed. โHeโs an old lagโan ex-convict. Served his time partly at Dartmoor. That, of course, is where he met Maitland or Marbury. Dโye see? Clear as noontide now, Spargo.โ Spargo sat drumming his fingers on the desk before him. His eyes were fixed on a map of London that hung on the opposite wall; his ears heard the throbbing of the printing-machines far below. But what he really saw was the faces of the two girls; what he really heard was the voices of two girls โฆ โClear as noontideโas noontide,โ repeated Rathbury with great cheerfulness. Spargo came back to the earth of plain and brutal fact. โWhatโs clear as noontide?โ he asked sharply. โWhat? Why, the whole thing! Motiveโeverything,โ answered Rathbury. โDonโt you see, Maitland and Aylmore (his real name is Ainsworth, by the by) meet at Dartmoor, probably, or, rather, certainly, just before Aylmoreโs release. Aylmore goes abroad, makes money, in time comes back, starts new career, gets into Parliament, becomes big man. In time, Maitland, who, after his time, has also gone abroad, also comes back. The two meet. Maitland probably tries to blackmail Aylmore or threatens to let folk know that the flourishing Mr. Aylmore, M.P., is an ex-convict. ResultโAylmore lures him to the Temple and quiets him. Pooh!โthe whole thingโs clear as noontide, as I say. Asโnoontide!โ Spargo drummed his fingers again. โHow?โ he asked quietly. โHow came Aylmore to be identified?โ โMy work,โ said Rathbury proudly. โMy work, my son. You see, I thought a lot. And especially after weโd found out that Marbury was Maitland.โ โYou mean after Iโd found out,โ remarked Spargo. Rathbury waved his cigar. โWell, well, itโs all the same,โ he said. โYou help me, and I help you, eh? Well, as I say, I thought a considerable lot. I thoughtโnow, where did Maitland, or Marbury, know or meet Aylmore twenty or twenty-two years ago? Not in London, because we knew Maitland never was in Londonโat any rate, before his trial, and we havenโt the least proof that he was in London after. And why wonโt Aylmore tell? Clearly because it must have been in some undesirable place. And then, all of a sudden, it flashed on me in a moment ofโwhat do you writing fellows call those moments, Spargo?โ โInspiration, I should think,โ said Spargo. โDirect inspiration.โ โThatโs it. In a moment of direct inspiration, it flashed on meโwhy, twenty years ago, Maitland was in Dartmoorโthey must have met there! And so, we got some old warders whoโd been there at that time to come to town, and we gave ’em opportunities to see Aylmore and to study him. Of course, heโs twenty years older, and heโs grown a beard, but they began to recall him, and then one man remembered that if he was the man they thought heโd a certain birth-mark. Andโhe has!โ โDoes Aylmore know that heโs been identified?โ asked Spargo. Rathbury pitched his cigar into the fireplace and laughed. โKnow!โ he said scornfully. โKnow? Heโs admitted it. What was the use of standing out against proof like that. He admitted it tonight in my presence. Oh, he knows all right!โ โAnd what did he say?โ Rathbury laughed contemptuously. โSay? Oh, not much. Pretty much what he said about this affairโthat when he was convicted the time before he was an innocent man. Heโs certainly a good hand at playing the innocent game.โ โAnd of what was he convicted?โ โOh, of course, we know all about itโnow. As soon as we found out who he really was, we had all the particulars turned up. Aylmore, or Ainsworth (Stephen Ainsworth his name really is) was a man who ran a sort of what they call a Mutual Benefit Society in a town right away up in the NorthโCloudhamptonโsome thirty years ago. He was nominally secretary, but it was really his own affair. It was patronized by the working classesโCloudhamptonโs a purely artisan populationโand they stuck a lot of their brass, as they call it, in it. Then suddenly it came to smash, and there was nothing. HeโAinsworth, or Aylmoreโpleaded that he was robbed and duped by another man, but the court didnโt believe him, and he got seven years. Plain story you see, Spargo, when it all comes out, eh?โ โAll stories are quite plainโwhen they come out,โ observed Spargo. โAnd he kept silence now, I suppose, because he didnโt want his daughters to know about his past?โ โJust so,โ agreed Rathbury. โAnd I donโt know that I blame him. He thought, of course, that heโd go scot-free over this Marbury affair. But he made his mistake in the initial stages, my boyโoh, yes!โ Spargo got up from his desk and walked around his room for a few minutes, Rathbury meanwhile finding and lighting another cigar. At last Spargo came back and clapped a hand on the detectiveโs shoulder. โLook here, Rathbury!โ he said. โItโs very evident that youโre now going on the lines that Aylmore did murder Marbury. Eh?โ Rathbury looked up. His face showed astonishment. โAfter evidence like that!โ he exclaimed. โWhy, of course. Thereโs the motive, my son, the motive!โ Spargo laughed. โRathbury!โ he said. โAylmore no more murdered Marbury than you did!โ The detective got up and put on his hat. โOh!โ he said. โPerhaps you know who did, then?โ โI shall know in a few days,โ answered Spargo. Rathbury stared wonderingly at him. Then he suddenly walked to the door. โGood-night!โ he said gruffly. โGood-night, Rathbury,โ replied Spargo and sat down at his desk. But that night Spargo wrote nothing for the _Watchman_. All he wrote was a short telegram addressed to Aylmoreโs daughters. There were only three words on itโ_Have no fear._ Chapter 29 – The Closed Doors. Alone of all the London morning newspapers, the _Watchman_ appeared next day destitute of sensationalism in respect to the Middle Temple Murder. The other daily journals published more or less vivid accounts of the identification of Mr. Stephen Aylmore, M.P. for the Brookminster Division, as the _ci-devant_ Stephen Ainsworth, ex-convict, once upon a time founder and secretary of the Hearth and Home Mutual Benefit Society, the headquarters of which had been at Cloudhampton, in Daleshire; the fall of which had involved thousands of honest working folk in terrible distress if not in absolute ruin. Most of them had raked up Ainsworthโs past to considerable journalistic purpose: it had been an easy matter to turn up old files, to recount the fall of the Hearth and Home, to tell anew the story of the privations of the humble investors whose small hoards had gone in the crash; it had been easy, too, to set out again the history of Ainsworthโs arrest, trial, and fate. There was plenty of romance in the story: it was that of a man who by his financial ability had built up a great industrial insurance society; hadโas was allegedโconverted the large sums entrusted to him to his own purposes; had been detected and punished; had disappeared, after his punishment, so effectually that no one knew where he had gone; had come back, comparatively a few years later, under another name, a very rich man, and had entered Parliament and been, in a modest way, a public character without any of those who knew him in his new career suspecting that he had once worn a dress liberally ornamented with the broad arrow. Fine copy, excellent copy: some of the morning newspapers made a couple of columns of it. But the _Watchman_, up to then easily ahead of all its contemporaries in keeping the public informed of all the latest news in connection with the Marbury affair, contented itself with a brief announcement. For after Rathbury had left him, Spargo had sought his proprietor and his editor, and had sat long in consultation with them, and the result of their talk had been that all the _Watchman_ thought fit to tell its readers next morning was contained in a curt paragraph: โWe understand that Mr. Stephen Aylmore, M.P., who is charged with the murder of John Marbury, or Maitland, in the Temple on June 21st last, was yesterday afternoon identified by certain officials as Stephen Ainsworth, who was sentenced to a term of penal servitude in connection with the Hearth and Home Mutual Benefit Society funds nearly thirty years ago.โ Coming down to Fleet Street that morning, Spargo, strolling jauntily along the front of the Law Courts, encountered a fellow-journalist, a man on an opposition newspaper, who grinned at him in a fashion which indicated derision. โLeft behind a bit, that rag of yours, this morning, Spargo, my boy!โ he remarked elegantly. โWhy, youโve missed one of the finest opportunities I ever heard of in connection with that Aylmore affair. A miserable paragraph!โwhy, I worked off a column and a half in ours! What were you doing last night, old man?โ โSleeping,โ said Spargo and went by with a nod. โSleeping!โ He left the other staring at him, and crossed the road to Middle Temple Lane. It was just on the stroke of eleven as he walked up the stairs to Mr. Elphickโs chambers; precisely eleven as he knocked at the outer door. It is seldom that outer doors are closed in the Temple at that hour, but Elphickโs door was closed fast enough. The night before it had been promptly opened, but there was no response to Spargoโs first knock, nor to his second, nor to his third. And half-unconsciously he murmured aloud: โElphickโs door is closed!โ It never occurred to Spargo to knock again: instinct told him that Elphickโs door was closed because Elphick was not there; closed because Elphick was not going to keep the appointment. He turned and walked slowly back along the corridor. And just as he reached the head of the stairs Ronald Breton, pale and anxious, came running up them, and at sight of Spargo paused, staring questioningly at him. As if with a mutual sympathy the two young men shook hands. โIโm glad you didnโt print more than those two or three lines in the _Watchman_ this morning,โ said Breton. โIt wasโconsiderate. As for the other papers!โAylmore assured me last night, Spargo, that though he did serve that term at Dartmoor he was innocent enough! He was scapegoat for another man who disappeared.โ Then, as Spargo merely nodded, he added, awkwardly: โAnd Iโm obliged to you, too, old chap, for sending that wire to the two girls last nightโit was good of you. They want all the comfort they can get, poor things! Butโwhat are you doing here, Spargo?โ Spargo leant against the head of the stairs and folded his hands. โI came here,โ he said, โto keep an appointment with Mr. Elphickโan appointment which he made when I called on him, as you suggested, at nine oโclock. The appointmentโa most important oneโwas for eleven oโclock.โ Breton glanced at his watch. โCome on, then,โ he said. โItโs well past that now, and my guardianโs a very martinet in the matter of punctuality.โ But Spargo did not move. Instead, he shook his head, regarding Breton with troubled eyes. โSo am I,โ he answered. โI was trained to it. Your guardian isnโt there, Breton.โ โNot there? If he made an appointment for eleven? NonsenseโI never knew him miss an appointment!โ โI knocked three timesโthree separate times,โ answered Spargo. โYou should have knocked half a dozen timesโhe may have overslept himself. He sits up lateโhe and old Cardlestone often sit up half the night, talking stamps or playing piquet,โ said Breton. โCome onโyouโll see!โ Spargo shook his head again. โHeโs not there, Breton,โ he said. โHeโs gone!โ Breton stared at the journalist as if he had just announced that he had seen Mr. Septimus Elphick riding down Fleet Street on a dromedary. He seized Spargoโs elbow. โCome on!โ he said. โI have a key to Mr. Elphickโs door, so that I can go in and out as I like. Iโll soon show you whether heโs gone or not.โ Spargo followed the young barrister down the corridor. โAll the same,โ he said meditatively as Breton fitted a key to the latch, โheโs not there, Breton. Heโsโoff!โ โGood heavens, man, I donโt know what youโre talking about!โ exclaimed Breton, opening the door and walking into the lobby. โOff! Where on earth should he be off to, when heโs made an appointment with you for eleven, andโHullo!โ He had opened the door of the room in which Spargo had met Elphick and Miss Baylis the night before, and was walking in when he pulled himself up on the threshold with a sharp exclamation. โGood God!โ he cried. โWhatโwhatโs all this?โ Spargo quietly looked over Bretonโs shoulder. It needed but one quick glance to show him that much had happened in that quiet room since he had quitted it the night before. There stood the easy-chair in which he had left Elphick; there, close by it, but pushed aside, as if by a hurried hand, was the little table with its spirit case, its syphon, its glass, in which stale liquid still stood; there was the novel, turned face downwards; there, upon the novel, was Elphickโs pipe. But the rest of the room was in dire confusion. The drawers of a bureau had been pulled open and never put back; papers of all descriptions, old legal-looking documents, old letters, littered the centre-table and the floor; in one corner of the room a black japanned box had been opened, its contents strewn about, and the lid left yawning. And in the grate, and all over the fender there were masses of burned and charred paper; it was only too evident that the occupant of the chambers, wherever he might have disappeared to, had spent some time before his disappearance in destroying a considerable heap of documents and papers, and in such haste that he had not troubled to put matters straight before he went. Breton stared at this scene for a moment in utter consternation. Then he made one step towards an inner door, and Spargo followed him. Together they entered an inner roomโa sleeping apartment. There was no one in it, but there were evidences that Elphick had just as hastily packed a bag as he had destroyed his papers. The clothes which Spargo had seen him wearing the previous evening were flung here, there, everywhere: the gorgeous smoking-jacket was tossed unceremoniously in one corner, a dress-shirt, in the bosom of which valuable studs still glistened, in another. One or two suitcases lay about, as if they had been examined and discarded in favour of something more portable; here, too, drawers, revealing stocks of linen and underclothing, had been torn open and left open; open, too, swung the door of a wardrobe, revealing a quantity of expensive clothing. And Spargo, looking around him, seemed to see all that had happenedโthe hasty, almost frantic search for and tearing up and burning of papers; the hurried change of clothing, of packing necessaries into a bag that could be carried, and then the flight the getting away, theโโ โWhat on earth does all this mean?โ exclaimed Breton. โWhat is it, Spargo?โ โI mean exactly what I told you,โ answered Spargo. โHeโs off! Off!โ โOff! But why off? Whatโmy guardian!โas quiet an old gentleman as there is in the Templeโoff!โ cried Breton. โFor what reason, eh? It isnโtโgood God, Spargo, it isnโt because of anything you said to him last night!โ โI should say it is precisely because of something that I said to him last night,โ replied Spargo. โI was a fool ever to let him out of my sight.โ Breton turned on his companion and gasped. โOutโofโyourโsight!โ he exclaimed. โWhyโwhyโyou donโt mean to say that Mr. Elphick has anything to do with this Marbury affair? For Godโs sake, Spargoโโโ Spargo laid a hand on the young barristerโs shoulder. โIโm afraid youโll have to hear a good deal, Breton,โ he said. โI was going to talk to you today in any case. You seeโโโ Before Spargo could say more a woman, bearing the implements which denote the charwomanโs profession, entered the room and immediately cried out at what she saw. Breton turned on her almost savagely. โHere, you!โ he said. โHave you seen anything of Mr. Elphick this morning?โ The charwoman rolled her eyes and lifted her hands. โMe, sir! Not a sign of him, sir. Which I never comes here much before half-past eleven, sir, Mr. Elphick being then gone out to his breakfast. I see him yesterday morning, sir, which he was then in his usual state of good health, sir, if any thingโs the matter with him now. No, sir, I ainโt seen nothing of him.โ Breton let out another exclamation of impatience. โYouโd better leave all this,โ he said. โMr. Elphickโs evidently gone away in a hurry, and you mustnโt touch anything here until he comes back. Iโm going to lock up the chambers: if youโve a key of them give it to me.โ The charwoman handed over a key, gave another astonished look at the rooms, and vanished, muttering, and Breton turned to Spargo. โWhat do you say?โ he demanded. โI must hearโa good deal! Out with it, then, man, for Heavenโs sake.โ But Spargo shook his head. โNot now, Breton,โ he answered. โPresently, I tell you, for Miss Aylmoreโs sake, and your own, the first thing to do is to get on your guardianโs track. We mustโmust, I say!โand at once.โ Breton stood staring at Spargo for a moment as if he could not credit his own senses. Then he suddenly motioned Spargo out of the room. โCome on!โ he said. โI know whoโll know where he is, if anybody does.โ โWho, then?โ asked Spargo, as they hurried out. โCardlestone,โ answered Breton, grimly. โCardlestone!โ Chapter 30 – Revelation. There was as much bright sunshine that morning in Middle Temple Lane as ever manages to get into it, and some of it was shining in the entry into which Spargo and Breton presently hurried. Full of haste as he was Breton paused at the foot of the stair. He looked down at the floor and at the wall at its side. โWasnโt it there?โ he said in a low voice, pointing at the place he looked at. โWasnโt it there, Spargo, just there, that Marbury, or, rather, Maitland, was found?โ โIt was just there,โ answered Spargo. โYou saw him?โ โI saw him.โ โSoonโafterwards?โ โImmediately after he was found. You know all that, Breton. Why do you ask now?โ Breton, who was still staring at the place on which he had fixed his eyes on walking into the entry, shook his head. โDonโt know,โ he answered. โIโbut come onโletโs see if old Cardlestone can tell us anything.โ There was another charwoman, armed with pails and buckets, outside Cardlestoneโs door, into which she was just fitting a key. It was evident to Spargo that she knew Breton, for she smiled at him as she opened the door. โI donโt think Mr. Cardlestoneโll be in, sir,โ she said. โHeโs generally gone out to breakfast at this timeโhim and Mr. Elphick goes together.โ โJust see,โ said Breton. โI want to see him if he is in.โ The charwoman entered the chambers and immediately screamed. โQuite so,โ remarked Spargo. โThatโs what I expected to hear. Cardlestone, you see, Breton, is alsoโoff!โ Breton made no reply. He rushed after the charwoman, with Spargo in close attendance. โGood Godโanother!โ groaned Breton. If the confusion in Elphickโs rooms had been bad, that in Cardlestoneโs chambers was worse. Here again all the features of the previous scene were repeatedโdrawers had been torn open, papers thrown about; the hearth was choked with light ashes; everything was at sixes and sevens. An open door leading into an inner room showed that Cardlestone, like Elphick, had hastily packed a bag; like Elphick had changed his clothes, and had thrown his discarded garments anywhere, into any corner. Spargo began to realize what had taken placeโElphick, having made his own preparations for flight, had come to Cardlestone, and had expedited him, and they had fled together. Butโwhy? The charwoman sat down in the nearest chair and began to moan and sob; Breton strode forward, across the heaps of papers and miscellaneous objects tossed aside in that hurried search and clearing up, into the inner room. And Spargo, looking about him, suddenly caught sight of something lying on the floor at which he made a sharp clutch. He had just secured it and hurried it into his pocket when Breton came back. โI donโt know what all this means, Spargo,โ he said, almost wearily. โI suppose you do. Look here,โ he went on, turning to the charwoman, โstop that rowโthatโll do no good, you know. I suppose Mr. Cardlestoneโs gone away in a hurry. Youโd betterโwhat had she better do, Spargo?โ โLeave things exactly as they are, lock up the chambers, and as youโre a friend of Mr. Cardlestoneโs give you the key,โ answered Spargo, with a significant glance. โDo that, now, and letโs goโIโve something to do.โ Once outside, with the startled charwoman gone away, Spargo turned to Breton. โIโll tell you all I know, presently, Breton,โ he said. โIn the meantime, I want to find out if the lodge porter saw Mr. Elphick or Mr. Cardlestone leave. I must know where theyโve goneโif I can only find out. I donโt suppose they went on foot.โ โAll right,โ responded Breton, gloomily. โWeโll go and ask. But this is all beyond me. You donโt mean to sayโโโ โWait a while,โ answered Spargo. โOne thing at once,โ he continued, as they walked up Middle Temple Lane. โThis is the first thing. You ask the porter if heโs seen anything of either of themโhe knows you.โ The porter, duly interrogated, responded with alacrity. โAnything of Mr. Elphick this morning, Mr. Breton?โ he answered. โCertainly, sir. I got a taxi for Mr. Elphick and Mr. Cardlestone early this morningโsoon after seven. Mr. Elphick said they were going to Paris, and theyโd breakfast at Charing Cross before the train left.โ โSay when theyโd be back?โ asked Breton, with an assumption of entire carelessness. โNo, sir, Mr. Elphick didnโt,โ answered the porter. โBut I should say they wouldnโt be long because theyโd only got small suit-cases with themโsuch as theyโd put a day or twoโs things in, sir.โ โAll right,โ said Breton. He turned away towards Spargo who had already moved off. โWhat next?โ he asked. โCharing Cross, I suppose!โ Spargo smiled and shook his head. โNo,โ he answered. โIโve no use for Charing Cross. They havenโt gone to Paris. That was all a blind. For the present letโs go back to your chambers. Then Iโll talk to you.โ Once within Bretonโs inner room, with the door closed upon them, Spargo dropped into an easy-chair and looked at the young barrister with earnest attention. โBreton!โ he said. โI believe weโre coming in sight of land. You want to save your prospective father-in-law, donโt you?โ โOf course!โ growled Breton. โThat goes without saying. Butโโโ โBut you may have to make some sacrifices in order to do it,โ said Spargo. โYou seeโโโ โSacrifices!โ exclaimed Breton. โWhatโโโ โYou may have to sacrifice some ideasโyou may find that youโll not be able to think as well of some people in the future as you have thought of them in the past. For instanceโMr. Elphick.โ Bretonโs face grew dark. โSpeak plainly, Spargo!โ he said. โItโs best with me.โ โVery well,โ replied Spargo. โMr. Elphick, then, is in some way connected with this affair.โ โYou mean theโmurder?โ โI mean the murder. So is Cardlestone. Of that Iโm now dead certain. And thatโs why theyโre off. I startled Elphick last night. Itโs evident that he immediately communicated with Cardlestone, and that they made a rapid exit. Why?โ โWhy? Thatโs what Iโm asking you! Why? Why? Why?โ โBecause theyโre afraid of something coming out. And being afraid, their first instinct is toโrun. Theyโve run at the first alarm. Foolishโbut instinctive.โ Breton, who had flung himself into the elbow-chair at his desk, jumped to his feet and thumped his blotting-pad. โSpargo!โ he exclaimed. โAre you telling me that you accuse my guardian and his friend, Mr. Cardlestone, of beingโmurderers?โ โNothing of the sort. I am accusing Mr. Elphick and Mr. Cardlestone of knowing more about the murder than they care to tell or want to tell. I am also accusing them, and especially your guardian, of knowing all about Maitland, alias Marbury. I made him confess last night that he knew this dead man to be John Maitland.โ โYou did!โ โI did. And now, Breton, since itโs got to come out, weโll have the truth. Pull yourself togetherโget your nerves ready, for youโll have to stand a shock or two. But I know what Iโm talking aboutโI can prove every word Iโm going to say to you. And first let me ask you a few questions. Do you know anything about your parentage?โ โNothingโbeyond what Mr. Elphick has told me. โAnd what was that?โ โThat my parents were old friends of his, who died young, leaving me unprovided for, and that he took me up and looked after me.โ โAnd heโs never given you any documentary evidence of any sort to prove the truth of that story?โ โNever! I never questioned his statement. Why should I?โ โYou never remember anything of your childhoodโI mean of any person who was particularly near you in your childhood?โ โI remember the people who brought me up from the time I was three years old. And I have just a faint, shadowy recollection of some woman, a tall, dark woman, I think, before that.โ โMiss Baylis,โ said Spargo to himself. โAll right, Breton,โ he went on aloud. โIโm going to tell you the truth. Iโll tell it to you straight out and give you all the explanations afterwards. Your real name is not Breton at all. Your real name is Maitland, and youโre the only child of the man who was found murdered at the foot of Cardlestoneโs staircase!โ Spargo had been wondering how Breton would take this, and he gazed at him with some anxiety as he got out the last words. What would he do?โwhat would he say?โwhatโโ Breton sat down quietly at his desk and looked Spargo hard between the eyes. โProve that to me, Spargo,โ he said, in hard, matter-of-fact tones. โProve it to me, every word. Every word, Spargo!โ Spargo nodded. โI willโevery word,โ he answered. โItโs the right thing. Listen, then.โ It was a quarter to twelve, Spargo noticed, throwing a glance at the clock outside, as he began his story; it was past one when he brought it to an end. And all that time Breton listened with the keenest attention, only asking a question now and then; now and then making a brief note on a sheet of paper which he had drawn to him. โThatโs all,โ said Spargo at last. โItโs plenty,โ observed Breton laconically. He sat staring at his notes for a moment; then he looked up at Spargo. โWhat do you really think?โ he asked. โAboutโwhat?โ said Spargo. โThis flight of Elphickโs and Cardlestoneโs.โ โI think, as I said, that they knew something which they think may be forced upon them. I never saw a man in a greater fright than that I saw Elphick in last night. And itโs evident that Cardlestone shares in that fright, or they wouldnโt have gone off in this way together.โ โDo you think they know anything of the actual murder?โ Spargo shook his head. โI donโt know. Probably. They know something. Andโlook here!โ Spargo put his hand in his breast pocket and drew something out which he handed to Breton, who gazed at it curiously. โWhatโs this?โ he demanded. โStamps?โ โThat, from the description of Criedir, the stamp-dealer, is a sheet of those rare Australian stamps which Maitland had on himโcarried on him. I picked it up just now in Cardlestoneโs room, when you were looking into his bedroom.โ โBut that, after all, proves nothing. Those maynโt be the identical stamps. And whether they are or notโโโ โWhat are the probabilities?โ interrupted Spargo sharply. โI believe that those are the stamps which Maitlandโyour father!โhad on him, and I want to know how they came to be in Cardlestoneโs rooms. And I will know.โ Breton handed the stamps back. โBut the general thing, Spargo?โ he said. โIf they didnโt murderโI canโt realize the thing yet!โmy fatherโโโ โIf they didnโt murder your father, they know who did!โ exclaimed Spargo. โNow, then, itโs time for more action. Let Elphick and Cardlestone alone for the momentโtheyโll be tracked easily enough. I want to tackle something else for the moment. How do you get an authority from the Government to open a grave?โ โOrder from the Home Secretary, which will have to be obtained by showing the very strongest reasons why it should be made.โ โGood! Weโll give the reasons. I want to have a grave opened.โ โA grave opened! Whose grave?โ โThe grave of the man Chamberlayne at Market Milcaster,โ replied Spargo. Breton started. โHis? In Heavenโs name, why?โ he demanded. Spargo laughed as he got up. โBecause I believe itโs empty,โ he answered. โBecause I believe that Chamberlayne is alive, and that his other name isโCardlestone!โ Chapter 31 – The Penitent Window-Cleaner. That afternoon Spargo had another of his momentous interviews with his proprietor and his editor. The first result was that all three drove to the offices of the legal gentleman who catered for the _Watchman_ when it wanted any law, and that things were put in shape for an immediate application to the Home Office for permission to open the Chamberlayne grave at Market Milcaster; the second was that on the following morning there appeared in the _Watchman_ a notice which set half the mouths of London a-watering. That notice; penned by Spargo, ran as follows:โ โONE THOUSAND POUNDS REWARD. โWHEREAS, on some date within the past twelve months, there was stolen, abstracted, or taken from the chambers in Fountain Court, Temple, occupied by Mr. Stephen Aylmore, M.P., under the name of Mr. Anderson, a walking-stick, or stout staff, of foreign make, and of curious workmanship, which stick was probably used in the murder of John Marbury, or Maitland, in Middle Temple Lane, on the night of June 21โ22 last, and is now in the hands of the police: โThis is to give notice that the Proprietor of the _Watchman_ newspaper will pay the above-mentioned reward (ONE THOUSAND POUNDS STERLING) at once and in cash to whosoever will prove that he or she stole, abstracted, or took away the said stick from the said chambers, and will further give full information as to his or her disposal of the same, and the Proprietor of the _Watchman_ moreover engages to treat any revelation affecting the said stick in the most strictly private and confidential manner, and to abstain from using it in any way detrimental to the informant, who should call at the _Watchman_ office, and ask for Mr. Frank Spargo at any time between eleven and one oโclock midday, and seven and eleven oโclock in the evening.โ โAnd you really expect to get some information through that?โ asked Breton, who came into Spargoโs room about noon on the day on which the promising announcement came out. โYou really do?โ โBefore today is out,โ said Spargo confidently. โThere is more magic in a thousand-pound reward than you fancy, Breton. Iโll have the history of that stick before midnight.โ โHow are you to tell that you wonโt be imposed upon?โ suggested Breton. โAnybody can say that he or she stole the stick.โ โWhoever comes here with any tale of a stick will have to prove to me how he or she got the stick and what was done with the stick,โ said Spargo. โI havenโt the least doubt that that stick was stolen or taken away from Aylmoreโs rooms in Fountain Court, and that it got into the hands ofโโ โYes, of whom?โ โThatโs what I want to know in some fashion. Iโve an idea, already. But I can afford to wait for definite information. I know one thingโwhen I get that informationโas I shallโwe shall be a long way on the road towards establishing Aylmoreโs innocence.โ Breton made no remark upon this. He was looking at Spargo with a meditative expression. โSpargo,โ he said, suddenly, โdo you think youโll get that order for the opening of the grave at Market Milcaster?โ โI was talking to the solicitors over the โphone just now,โ answered Spargo. โTheyโve every confidence about it. In fact, itโs possible it may be made this afternoon. In that case, the opening will be made early tomorrow morning.โ โShall you go?โ asked Breton. โCertainly. And you can go with me, if you like. Better keep in touch with us all day in case we hear. You ought to be thereโyouโre concerned.โ โI should like to goโI will go,โ said Breton. โAnd if that grave proves to beโemptyโIโllโIโll tell you something.โ Spargo looked up with sharp instinct. โYouโll tell me something? Something? What?โ โNever mindโwait until we see if that coffin contains a dead body or lead and sawdust. If thereโs no body thereโโโ At that moment one of the senior messenger boys came in and approached Spargo. His countenance, usually subdued to an official stolidity, showed signs of something very like excitement. โThereโs a man downstairs asking for you, Mr. Spargo,โ he said. โHeโs been hanging about a bit, sir,โseems very shy about coming up. He wonโt say what he wants, and he wonโt fill up a form, sir. Says all he wants is a word or two with you.โ โBring him up at once!โ commanded Spargo. He turned to Breton when the boy had gone. โThere!โ he said, laughing. โThis is the man about the stickโyou see if it isnโt.โ โYouโre such a cock-sure chap, Spargo,โ said Breton. โYouโre always going on a straight line.โ โTrying to, you mean,โ retorted Spargo. โWell, stop here, and hear what this chap has to say: itโll no doubt be amusing.โ The messenger boy, deeply conscious that he was ushering into Spargoโs room an individual who might shortly carry away a thousand pounds of good _Watchman_ money in his pocket, opened the door and introduced a shy and self-conscious young man, whose nervousness was painfully apparent to everybody and deeply felt by himself. He halted on the threshold, looking round the comfortably-furnished room, and at the two well-dressed young men which it framed as if he feared to enter on a scene of such grandeur. โCome in, come in!โ said Spargo, rising and pointing to an easy-chair at the side of his desk. โTake a seat. Youโve called about that reward, of course.โ The man in the chair eyed the two of them cautiously, and not without suspicion. He cleared his throat with a palpable effort. โOf course,โ he said. โItโs all on the strict private. Name of Edward Mollison, sir.โ โAnd where do you live, and what do you do?โ asked Spargo. โYou might put it down Rowton House, Whitechapel,โ answered Edward Mollison. โLeastways, thatโs where I generally hang out when I can afford it. Andโwindow-cleaner. Leastways, I was window cleaning whenโwhenโโโ โWhen you came in contact with the stick weโve been advertising about,โ suggested Spargo. โJust so. Well, Mollisonโwhat about the stick?โ Mollison looked round at the door, and then at the windows, and then at Breton. โThere ainโt no danger of me being got into trouble along of that stick?โ he asked. โโCause if there is, I ainโt a-going to say a wordโno, not for no thousand pounds! Me never having been in no trouble of any sort, guvโnorโthough a poor man.โ โNot the slightest danger in the world, Mollison,โ replied Spargo. โNot the least. All youโve got to do is to tell the truthโand prove that it is the truth. So it was you who took that queer-looking stick out of Mr. Aylmoreโs rooms in Fountain Court, was it?โ Mollison appeared to find this direct question soothing to his feelings. He smiled weakly. โIt was certโnly me as took it, sir,โ he said. โNot that I meant to pinch itโnot me! And, as you might say, I didnโt take it, when allโs said and done. It wasโput on me.โ โPut on you, was it?โ said Spargo. โThatโs interesting. And how was it put on you?โ Mollison grinned again and rubbed his chin. โIt was this here way,โ he answered. โYou see, I was working at that timeโnear on to nine months since, it isโfor the Universal Daylight Window Cleaning Company, and I used to clean a many windows here and there in the Temple, and them windows at Mr. Aylmoreโsโonly I knew them as Mr. Andersonโsโamong ’em. And I was there one morning, early it was, when the charwoman she says to me, โI wish youโd take these two or three hearthrugs,โ she says, โand give ’em a good beating,โ she says. And me being always a ready one to oblige, โAll right!โ I says, and takes ’em. โHereโs something to wallop ’em with,โ she says, and pulls that there old stick out of a lot that was in a stand in a corner of the lobby. And thatโs how I came to handle it, sir.โ โI see,โ said Spargo. โA good explanation. And when you had beaten the hearthrugsโwhat then?โ Mollison smiled his weak smile again. โWell, sir, I looked at that there stick and I see it was something uncommon,โ he answered. โAnd I thinksโโWell, this Mr. Anderson, heโs got a bundle of sticks and walking canes up thereโheโll never miss this old thing,โ I thinks. And so I left it in a corner when Iโd done beating the rugs, and when I went away with my things I took it with me.โ โYou took it with you?โ said Spargo. โJust so. To keep as a curiosity, I suppose?โ Mollisonโs weak smile turned to one of cunning. He was obviously losing his nervousness; the sound of his own voice and the reception of his news was imparting confidence to him. โNot half!โ he answered. โYou see, guvโnor, there was an old cove as I knew in the Temple there as is, or was, ’cause I ainโt been there since, a collector of antikities, like, and Iโd sold him a queer old thing, time and again. And, of course, I had him in my eye when I took the stick awayโsee?โ โI see. And you took the stick to him?โ โI took it there and then,โ replied Mollison. โPitched him a tale, I did, about it having been brought from foreign parts by Uncle Simonโwhich I never had no Uncle Simon. Made out it was a rare curiosityโwhich it might haโ been one, for all I know.โ โExactly. And the old cove took a fancy to it, eh?โ โBought it there and then,โ answered Mollison, with something very like a wink. โAh! Bought it there and then. And how much did he give you for it?โ asked Spargo. โSomething handsome, I hope?โ โCouple oโ quid,โ replied Mollison. โMe not wishing to part with a family heirloom for less.โ โJust so. And do you happen to be able to tell me the old coveโs name and his address, Mollison?โ asked Spargo. โI do, sir. Which theyโve painted on his entryโthe fifth or sixth as you go down Middle Temple Lane,โ answered Mollison. โMr. Nicholas Cardlestone, first floor up the staircase.โ Spargo rose from his seat without as much as a look at Breton. โCome this way, Mollison,โ he said. โWeโll go and see about your little reward. Excuse me, Breton.โ Breton kicked his heels in solitude for half an hour. Then Spargo came back. โThereโthatโs one matter settled, Breton,โ he said. โNow for the next. The Home Secretaryโs made the order for the opening of the grave at Market Milcaster. Iโm going down there at once, and I suppose youโre coming. And remember, if that graveโs emptyโโโ โIf that graveโs empty,โ said Breton, โIโll tell youโa good deal.โ Chapter 32 – The Contents of the Coffin. There travelled down together to Market Milcaster late that afternoon, Spargo, Breton, the officials from the Home Office, entrusted with the order for the opening of the Chamberlayne grave, and a solicitor acting on behalf of the proprietor of the _Watchman_. It was late in the evening when they reached the little town, but Spargo, having looked in at the parlour of the โYellow Dragonโ and ascertained that Mr. Quarterpage had only just gone home, took Breton across the street to the old gentlemanโs house. Mr. Quarterpage himself came to the door, and recognized Spargo immediately. Nothing would satisfy him but that the two should go in; his family, he said, had just retired, but he himself was going to take a final nightcap and a cigar, and they must share it. โFor a few minutes only then, Mr. Quarterpage,โ said Spargo as they followed the old man into his dining-room. โWe have to be up at daybreak. Andโpossiblyโyou, too, would like to be up just as early.โ Mr. Quarterpage looked an enquiry over the top of a decanter which he was handling. โAt daybreak?โ he exclaimed. โThe fact is,โ said Spargo, โthat grave of Chamberlayneโs is going to be opened at daybreak. We have managed to get an order from the Home Secretary for the exhumation of Chamberlayneโs body: the officials in charge of it have come down in the same train with us; weโre all staying across there at the โDragon.โ The officials have gone to make the proper arrangements with your authorities. It will be at daybreak, or as near it as can conveniently be managed. And I suppose, now that you know of it, youโll be there?โ โGod bless me!โ exclaimed Mr. Quarterpage. โYouโve really done that! Well, well, so we shall know the truth at last, after all these years. Youโre a very wonderful young man, Mr. Spargo, upon my word. And this other young gentleman?โ Spargo looked at Breton, who had already given him permission to speak. โMr. Quarterpage,โ he said, โthis young gentleman is, without doubt, John Maitlandโs son. Heโs the young barrister, Mr. Ronald Breton, that I told you of, but thereโs no doubt about his parentage. And Iโm sure youโll shake hands with him and wish him well.โ Mr. Quarterpage set down decanter and glass and hastened to give Breton his hand. โMy dear young sir!โ he exclaimed. โThat I will indeed! And as to wishing you wellโah, I never wished anything but well to your poor father. He was led away, sir, led away by Chamberlayne. God bless me, what a night of surprises! Why, Mr. Spargo, supposing that coffin is found emptyโwhat then?โ โThen,โ answered Spargo, โthen I think we shall be able to put our hands on the man who is supposed to be in it.โ โYou think my father was worked upon by this man Chamberlayne, sir?โ observed Breton a few minutes later when they had all sat down round Mr. Quarterpageโs hospitable hearth. โYou think he was unduly influenced by him?โ Mr. Quarterpage shook his head sadly. โChamberlayne, my dear young sir,โ he answered. โChamberlayne was a plausible and a clever fellow. Nobody knew anything about him until he came to this town, and yet before he had been here very long he had contrived to ingratiate himself with everybodyโof course, to his own advantage. I firmly believe that he twisted your father round his little finger. As I told Mr. Spargo there when he was making his enquiries of me a short while back, it would never have been any surprise to me to hearโdefinitely, I mean, young gentlemenโthat all this money that was in question went into Chamberlayneโs pockets. Dear meโdear me!โand you really believe that Chamberlayne is actually alive, Mr. Spargo?โ Spargo pulled out his watch. โWe shall all know whether he was buried in that grave before another six hours are over, Mr. Quarterpage,โ he said. He might well have spoken of four hours instead of six, for it was then nearly midnight, and before three oโclock Spargo and Breton, with the other men who had accompanied them from London were out of the โYellow Dragonโ and on their way to the cemetery just outside the little town. Over the hills to the eastward the grey dawn was slowly breaking: the long stretch of marshland which lies between Market Milcaster and the sea was white with fog: on the cypresses and acacias of the cemetery hung veils and webs of gossamer: everything around them was quiet as the dead folk who lay beneath their feet. And the people actively concerned went quietly to work, and those who could do nothing but watch stood around in silence. โIn all my long life of over ninety years,โ whispered old Quarterpage, who had met them at the cemetery gates, looking fresh and brisk in spite of his shortened rest, โI have never seen this done before. It seems a strange, strange thing to interfere with a dead manโs last resting-placeโa dreadful thing.โ โIf there is a dead man there,โ said Spargo. He himself was mainly curious about the details of this exhumation; he had no scruples, sentimental or otherwise, about the breaking in upon the dead. He watched all that was done. The men employed by the local authorities, instructed over-night, had fenced in the grave with canvas; the proceedings were accordingly conducted in strict privacy; a man was posted to keep away any very early passersby, who might be attracted by the unusual proceedings. At first there was nothing to do but wait, and Spargo occupied himself by reflecting that every spadeful of earth thrown out of that grave was bringing him nearer to the truth; he had an unconquerable intuition that the truth of at any rate one phase of the Marbury case was going to be revealed to them. If the coffin to which they were digging down contained a body, and that the body of the stockbroker, Chamberlayne, then a good deal of his, Spargoโs, latest theory, would be dissolved to nothingness. But if that coffin contained no body at all, thenโโ โTheyโre down to it!โ whispered Breton. Presently they all went and looked down into the grave. The workmen had uncovered the coffin preparatory to lifting it to the surface; one of them was brushing the earth away from the name-plate. And in the now strong light they could all read the lettering on it. JAMES CARTWRIGHT CHAMBERLAYNE Born 1852 Died 1891 Spargo turned away as the men began to lift the coffin out of the grave. โWe shall know now!โ he whispered to Breton. โAnd yetโwhat is it we shall know ifโโโ โIf what?โ said Breton. โIfโwhat?โ But Spargo shook his head. This was one of the great moments he had lately been working for, and the issues were tremendous. โNow for it!โ said the _Watchmanโs_ solicitor in an undertone. โCome, Mr. Spargo, now we shall see.โ They all gathered round the coffin, set on low trestles at the graveside, as the workmen silently went to work on the screws. The screws were rusted in their sockets; they grated as the men slowly worked them out. It seemed to Spargo that each man grew slower and slower in his movements; he felt that he himself was getting fidgety. Then he heard a voice of authority. โLift the lid off!โ A man at the head of the coffin, a man at the foot suddenly and swiftly raised the lid: the men gathered round craned their necks with a quick movement. Sawdust! The coffin was packed to the brim with sawdust, tightly pressed down. The surface lay smooth, undisturbed, levelled as some hand had levelled it long years before. They were not in the presence of death, but of deceit. Somebody laughed faintly. The sound of the laughter broke the spell. The chief official present looked round him with a smile. โIt is evident that there were good grounds for suspicion,โ he remarked. โHere is no dead body, gentlemen. See if anything lies beneath the sawdust,โ he added, turning to the workmen. โTurn it out!โ The workmen began to scoop out the sawdust with their hands; one of them, evidently desirous of making sure that no body was in the coffin, thrust down his fingers at various places along its length. He, too, laughed. โThe coffinโs weighted with lead!โ he remarked. โSee!โ And tearing the sawdust aside, he showed those around him that at three intervals bars of lead had been tightly wedged into the coffin where the head, the middle, and the feet of a corpse would have rested. โDone it cleverly,โ he remarked, looking round. โYou see how these weights have been adjusted. When a bodyโs laid out in a coffin, you know, all the weightโs in the end where the head and trunk rest. Here you see the heaviest bar of lead is in the middle; the lightest at the feet. Clever!โ โClear out all the sawdust,โ said some one. โLetโs see if thereโs anything else.โ There was something else. At the bottom of the coffin two bundles of papers, tied up with pink tape. The legal gentlemen present immediately manifested great interest in these. So did Spargo, who, pulling Breton along with him, forced his way to where the officials from the Home Office and the solicitor sent by the _Watchman_ were hastily examining their discoveries. The first bundle of papers opened evidently related to transactions at Market Milcaster: Spargo caught glimpses of names that were familiar to him, Mr. Quarterpageโs amongst them. He was not at all astonished to see these things. But he was something more than astonished when, on the second parcel being opened, a quantity of papers relating to Cloudhampton and the Hearth and Home Mutual Benefit Society were revealed. He gave a hasty glance at these and drew Breton aside. โIt strikes me weโve found a good deal more than we ever bargained for!โ he exclaimed. โDidnโt Aylmore say that the real culprit at Cloudhampton was another manโhis clerk or something of that sort?โ โHe did,โ agreed Breton. โHe insists on it.โ โThen this fellow Chamberlayne must have been the man,โ said Spargo. โHe came to Market Milcaster from the north. Whatโll be done with those papers?โ he asked, turning to the officials. โWe are going to seal them up at once, and take them to London,โ replied the principal person in authority. โThey will be quite safe, Mr. Spargo; have no fear. We donโt know what they may reveal.โ โYou donโt, indeed!โ said Spargo. โBut I may as well tell you that I have a strong belief that theyโll reveal a good deal that nobody dreams of, so take the greatest care of them.โ Then, without waiting for further talk with any one, Spargo hurried Breton out of the cemetery. At the gate, he seized him by the arm. โNow, then, Breton!โ he commanded. โOut with it!โ โWith what?โ โYou promised to tell me somethingโa great deal, you saidโif we found that coffin empty. It is empty. Come onโquick!โ โAll right. I believe I know where Elphick and Cardlestone can be found. Thatโs all.โ โAll! Itโs enough. Where, then, in heavenโs name?โ โElphick has a queer little place where he and Cardlestone sometimes go fishingโright away up in one of the wildest parts of the Yorkshire moors. I expect theyโve gone there. Nobody knows even their names thereโthey could go and lie quiet there forโages.โ โDo you know the way to it?โ โI doโIโve been there.โ Spargo motioned him to hurry. โCome on, then,โ he said. โWeโre going there by the very first train out of this. I know the train, tooโweโve just time to snatch a mouthful of breakfast and to send a wire to the _Watchman_, and then weโll be off. Yorkshire!โGad, Breton, thatโs over three hundred miles away!โ Chapter 33 – Forestalled. Travelling all that long summer day, first from the south-west of England to the Midlands, then from the Midlands to the north, Spargo and Breton came late at night to Hawesโ Junction, on the border of Yorkshire and Westmoreland, and saw rising all around them in the half-darkness the mighty bulks of the great fells which rise amongst that wild and lonely stretch of land. At that hour of the night and amidst that weird silence, broken only by the murmur of some adjacent waterfall the scene was impressive and suggestive; it seemed to Spargo as if London were a million miles away, and the rush and bustle of human life a thing of another planet. Here and there in the valleys he saw a light, but such lights were few and far between; even as he looked some of them twinkled and went out. It was evident that he and Breton were presently to be alone with the night. โHow far?โ he asked Breton as they walked away from the station. โWeโd better discuss matters,โ answered Breton. โThe place is in a narrow valley called Fossdale, some six or seven miles away across these fells, and as wild a walk as any lover of such things could wish for. Itโs half-past nine now, Spargo: I reckon it will take us a good two and a half hours, if not more, to do it. Now, the question isโDo we go straight there, or do we put up for the night? Thereโs an inn here at this junction: thereโs the Moor Cock Inn a mile or so along the road which we must take before we turn off to the moorland and the fells. Itโs going to be a black nightโlook at those masses of black cloud gathering there!โand possibly a wet one, and weโve no waterproofs. But itโs for you to sayโIโm game for whatever you like.โ โDo you know the way?โ asked Spargo. โIโve been the way. In the daytime I could go straight ahead. I remember all the landmarks. Even in the darkness I believe I can find my way. But itโs rough walking.โ โWeโll go straight there,โ said Spargo. โEvery minuteโs precious. Butโcan we get a mouthful of bread and cheese and a glass of ale first?โ โGood idea! Weโll call in at the โMoor Cock. โ Now then, while weโre on this firm road, step it out lively.โ The โMoor Cockโ was almost deserted at that hour: there was scarcely a soul in it when the two travellers turned in to its dimly-lighted parlour. The landlord, bringing the desired refreshment, looked hard at Breton. โCome our way again then, sir?โ he remarked with a sudden grin of recognition. โAh, you remember me?โ said Breton. โI call in mind when you came here with the two old gents last year,โ replied the landlord. โI hear theyโre here againโTom Summers was coming across that way this morning, and said heโd seen ’em at the little cottage. Going to join ’em, I reckon, sir?โ Breton kicked Spargo under the table. โYes, weโre going to have a day or two with them,โ he answered. โJust to get a breath of your moorland air.โ โWell, youโll have a roughish walk over there tonight, gentlemen,โ said the landlord. โThereโs going to be a storm. And itโs a stiffish way to make out at this time oโnight.โ โOh, weโll manage,โ said Breton, nonchalantly. โI know the way, and weโre not afraid of a wet skin.โ The landlord laughed, and sitting down on his long settle folded his arms and scratched his elbows. โThere was a gentlemanโLondon gentleman by his tongueโcame in here this afternoon, and asked the way to Fossdale,โ he observed. โHeโll be there long sinceโheโd have daylight for his walk. Happen heโs one of your party?โhe asked where the old gentlemenโs little cottage was.โ Again Spargo felt his shin kicked and made no sign. โOne of their friends, perhaps,โ answered Breton. โWhat was he like?โ The landlord ruminated. He was not good at description and was conscious of the fact. โWell, a darkish, serious-faced gentleman,โ he said. โStranger hereabouts, at all events. Wore a grey suitโsomething like your friendโs there. Yesโhe took some bread and cheese with him when he heard what a long way it was.โ โWise man,โ remarked Breton. He hastily finished his own bread and cheese, and drank off the rest of his pint of ale. โCome on,โ he said, โletโs be stepping.โ Outside, in the almost tangible darkness, Breton clutched Spargoโs arm. โWhoโs the man?โ he said. โCan you think, Spargo?โ โCanโt,โ answered Spargo. โI was trying to, while that chap was talking. Butโitโs somebody thatโs got in before us. Not Rathbury, anyhowโheโs not serious-faced. Heavens, Breton, however are you going to find your way in this darkness?โ โYouโll see presently. We follow the road a little. Then we turn up the fell side there. On the top, if the night clears a bit, we ought to see Great Shunnor Fell and Lovely Seatโtheyโre both well over two thousand feet, and they stand up well. We want to make for a point clear between them. But I warn you, Spargo, itโs stiff going!โ โGo ahead!โ said Spargo. โItโs the first time in my life I ever did anything of this sort, but weโre going on if it takes us all night. I couldnโt sleep in any bed now that Iโve heard thereโs somebody ahead of us. Go first, old chap, and Iโll follow.โ Breton went steadily forward along the road. That was easy work, but when he turned off and began to thread his way up the fell-side by what was obviously no more than a sheep-track, Spargoโs troubles began. It seemed to him that he was walking as in a nightmare; all that he saw was magnified and heightened; the darkening sky above; the faint outlines of the towering hills; the gaunt spectres of fir and pine; the figure of Breton forging stolidly and surely ahead. Now the ground was soft and spongy under his feet; now it was stony and rugged; more than once he caught an ankle in the wire-like heather and tripped, bruising his knees. And in the end he resigned himself to keeping his eye on Breton, outlined against the sky, and following doggedly in his footsteps. โWas there no other way than this?โ he asked after a long interval of silence. โDo you mean to say those twoโElphick and Cardlestoneโwould take this way?โ โThere is another wayโdown the valley, by Thwaite Bridge and Hardraw,โ answered Breton, โbut itโs miles and miles round. This is a straight cut across country, and in daylight itโs a delightful walk. But at nightโGad!โhereโs the rain, Spargo!โ The rain came down as it does in that part of the world, with a suddenness that was as fierce as it was heavy. The whole of the grey night was blotted out; Spargo was only conscious that he stood in a vast solitude and was being gradually drowned. But Breton, whose sight was keener, and who had more knowledge of the situation dragged his companion into the shelter of a group of rocks. He laughed a little as they huddled closely together. โThis is a different sort of thing to pursuing detective work in Fleet Street, Spargo,โ he said. โYou would come on, you know.โ โIโm going on if we go through cataracts and floods,โ answered Spargo. โI might have been induced to stop at the โMoor Cockโ overnight if we hadnโt heard of that chap in front. If heโs after those two heโs somebody who knows something. What I canโt make out isโwho he can be.โ โNor I,โ said Breton. โI canโt think of anybody who knows of this retreat. Butโhas it ever struck you, Spargo, that somebody beside yourself may have been investigating?โ โPossible,โ replied Spargo. โOne never knows. I only wish weโd been a few hours earlier. For I wanted to have the first word with those two.โ The rain ceased as suddenly as it had come. Just as suddenly the heavens cleared. And going forward to the top of the ridge which they were then crossing, Breton pointed an arm to something shining far away below them. โYou see that?โ he said. โThatโs a sheet of water lying between us and Cotterdale. We leave that on our right hand, climb the fell beyond it, drop down into Cotterdale, cross two more ranges of fell, and come down into Fossdale under Lovely Seat. Thereโs a good two hours and a half stiff pull yet, Spargo. Think you can stick it?โ Spargo set his teeth. โGo on!โ he said. Up hill, down dale, now up to his ankles in peaty ground, now tearing his shins, now bruising his knees, Spargo, yearning for the London lights, the well-paved London streets, the convenient taxi-cab, even the humble omnibus, plodded forward after his guide. It seemed to him that they had walked for ages and had traversed a whole continent of mountains and valley when at last Breton, halting on the summit of a wind-swept ridge, laid one hand on his companionโs shoulder and pointed downward with the other. โThere!โ he said. โThere!โ Spargo looked ahead into the night. Far away, at what seemed to him to be a considerable distance, he saw the faint, very faint glimmer of a lightโa mere spark of a light. โThatโs the cottage,โ said Breton, โLate as it is, you see, theyโre up. And hereโs the roughest bit of the journey. Itโll take me all my time to find the track across this moor, Spargo, so step carefully after meโthere are bogs and holes hereabouts.โ Another hour had gone by ere the two came to the cottage. Sometimes the guiding light had vanished, blotted out by intervening rises in the ground; always, when they saw it again, they were slowly drawing nearer to it. And now when they were at last close to it, Spargo realized that he found himself in one of the loneliest places he had ever been capable of imaginingโso lonely and desolate a spot he had certainly never seen. In the dim light he could see a narrow, crawling stream, making its way down over rocks and stones from the high ground of Great Shunnor Fell. Opposite to the place at which they stood, on the edge of the moorland, a horseshoe like formation of ground was backed by a ring of fir and pine; beneath this protecting fringe of trees stood a small building of grey stone which looked as if it had been originally built by some shepherd as a pen for the moorland sheep. It was of no more than one storey in height, but of some length; a considerable part of it was hidden by shrubs and brushwood. And from one uncurtained, blindless window the light of a lamp shone boldly into the fading darkness without. Breton pulled up on the edge of the crawling stream. โWeโve got to get across there, Spargo,โ he said. โBut as weโre already soaked to the knee it doesnโt matter about getting another wetting. Have you any idea how long weโve been walking?โ โHoursโdaysโyears!โ replied Spargo. โI should say quite four hours,โ said Breton. โIn that case, itโs well past two oโclock, and the light will be breaking in another hour or so. Now, once across this stream, what shall we do?โ โWhat have we come to do? Go to the cottage, of course!โ โWait a bit. No need to startle them. By the fact theyโve got a light, I take it that theyโre up. Look there!โ As he spoke, a figure crossed the window passing between it and the light. โThatโs not Elphick, nor yet Cardlestone,โ said Spargo. โTheyโre medium-heighted men. Thatโs a tallish man.โ โThen itโs the man the landlord of the โMoor Cockโ told us about,โ said Breton. โNow, look hereโI know every inch of this place. When weโre across let me go up to the cottage, and Iโll take an observation through that window and see whoโs inside. Come on.โ He led Spargo across the stream at a place where a succession of boulders made a natural bridge, and bidding him keep quiet, went up the bank to the cottage. Spargo, watching him, saw him make his way past the shrubs and undergrowth until he came to a great bush which stood between the lighted window and the projecting porch of the cottage. He lingered in the shadow of this bush but for a short moment; then came swiftly and noiselessly back to his companion. His hand fell on Spargoโs arm with a clutch of nervous excitement. โSpargo!โ he whispered. โWho on earth do you think the other man is?โ Chapter 34 – The Whip Hand. Spargo, almost irritable from desire to get at close grips with the objects of his long journey, shook off Bretonโs hand with a growl of resentment. โAnd how on earth can I waste time guessing?โ he exclaimed. โWho is he?โ Breton laughed softly. โSteady, Spargo, steady!โ he said. โItโs Myerstโthe Safe Deposit man. Myerst!โ Spargo started as if something had bitten him. โMyerst!โ he almost shouted. โMyerst! Good Lord!โwhy did I never think of him? Myerst! Thenโโโ โI donโt know why you should have thought of him,โ said Breton. โButโheโs there.โ Spargo took a step towards the cottage: Breton pulled him back. โWait!โ he said. โWeโve got to discuss this. Iโd better tell you what theyโre doing.โ โWhat are they doing, then?โ demanded Spargo impatiently. โWell,โ answered Breton. โTheyโre going through a quantity of papers. The two old gentlemen look very ill and very miserable. Myerst is evidently laying down the law to them in some fashion or other. Iโve formed a notion, Spargo.โ โWhat notion?โ โMyerst is in possession of whatever secret they have, and heโs followed them down here to blackmail them. Thatโs my notion.โ Spargo thought awhile, pacing up and down the river bank. โI daresay youโre right,โ he said. โNow, whatโs to be done?โ Breton, too, considered matters. โI wish,โ he said at last, โI wish we could get in there and overhear whatโs going on. But thatโs impossibleโI know that cottage. The only thing we can do is thisโwe must catch Myerst unawares. Heโs here for no good. Look here!โ And reaching round to his hip-pocket Breton drew out a Browning revolver and wagged it in his hand with a smile. โThatโs a useful thing to have, Spargo,โ he remarked. โI slipped it into my pocket the other day, wondering why on earth I did it. Now itโll come in handy. For anything we know Myerst may be armed.โ โWell?โ said Spargo. โCome up to the cottage. If things turn out as I think they will, Myerst, when heโs got what he wants, will be off. Now, you shall get where I did just now, behind that bush, and Iโll station myself in the doorway. You can report to me, and when Myerst comes out Iโll cover him. Come on, Spargo; itโs beginning to get light already.โ Breton cautiously led the way along the river bank, making use of such cover as the willows and alders afforded. Together, he and Spargo made their way to the front of the cottage. Arrived at the door, Breton posted himself in the porch, motioning to Spargo to creep in behind the bushes and to look through the window. And Spargo noiselessly followed his directions and slightly parting the branches which concealed him looked in through the uncurtained glass. The interior into which he looked was rough and comfortless in the extreme. There were the bare accessories of a moorland cottage; rough chairs and tables, plastered walls, a fishing rod or two piled in a corner; some food set out on a side table. At the table in the middle of the floor the three men sat. Cardlestoneโs face was in the shadow; Myerst had his back to the window; old Elphick bending over the table was laboriously writing with shaking fingers. And Spargo twisted his head round to his companion. โElphick,โ he said, โis writing a cheque. Myerst has another cheque in his hand. Be ready!โwhen he gets that second cheque I guess heโll be off.โ Breton smiled grimly and nodded. A moment later Spargo whispered again. โLook out, Breton! Heโs coming.โ Breton drew back into the angle of the porch; Spargo quitted his protecting bush and took the other angle. The door opened. And they heard Myerstโs voice, threatening, commanding in tone. โNow, remember all Iโve said! And donโt you forgetโIโve the whip hand of both of youโthe whip hand!โ Then Myerst turned and stepped out into the grey lightโto find himself confronted by an athletic young man who held the muzzle of an ugly revolver within two inches of the bridge of his nose and in a remarkably firm and steady grip. Another glance showed him the figure of a second business-like looking young man at his side, whose attitude showed a desire to grapple with him. โGood-morning, Mr. Myerst,โ said Breton with cold and ironic politeness. โWe are glad to meet you so unexpectedly. AndโI must trouble you to put up your hands. Quick!โ Myerst made one hurried movement of his right hand towards his hip, but a sudden growl from Breton made him shift it just as quickly above his head, whither the left followed it. Breton laughed softly. โThatโs wise, Mr. Myerst,โ he said, keeping his revolver steadily pointed at his prisonerโs nose. โDiscretion will certainly be the better part of your valour on this occasion. Spargoโmay I trouble you to see what Mr. Myerst carries in his pockets? Go through them carefully. Not for papers or documentsโjust now. We can leave that matterโweโve plenty of time. See if heโs got a weapon of any sort on him, Spargoโthatโs the important thing.โ Considering that Spargo had never gone through the experience of searching a man before, he made sharp and creditable work of seeing what the prisoner carried. And he forthwith drew out and exhibited a revolver, while Myerst, finding his tongue, cursed them both, heartily and with profusion. โExcellent!โ said Breton, laughing again. โSure heโs got nothing else on him thatโs dangerous, Spargo? All right. Now, Mr. Myerst, right about face! Walk into the cottage, hands up, and remember there are two revolvers behind your back. March!โ Myerst obeyed this peremptory order with more curses. The three walked into the cottage. Breton kept his eye on his captive; Spargo gave a glance at the two old men. Cardlestone, white and shaking, was lying back in his chair; Elphick, scarcely less alarmed, had risen, and was coming forward with trembling limbs. โWait a moment,โ said Breton, soothingly. โDonโt alarm yourself. Weโll deal with Mr. Myerst here first. Now, Myerst, my man, sit down in that chairโitโs the heaviest the place affords. Into it, now! Spargo, you see that coil of rope there. Tie Myerst upโhand and footโto that chair. And tie him well. All the knots to be double, Spargo, and behind him.โ Myerst suddenly laughed. โYou damned young bully!โ he exclaimed. โIf you put a rope round me, youโre only putting ropes round the necks of these two old villains. Mark that, my fine fellows!โ โWeโll see about that later,โ answered Breton. He kept Myerst covered while Spargo made play with the rope. โDonโt be afraid of hurting him, Spargo,โ he said. โTie him well and strong. He wonโt shift that chair in a hurry.โ Spargo spliced his man to the chair in a fashion that would have done credit to a sailor. He left Myerst literally unable to move either hand or foot, and Myerst cursed him from crown to heel for his pains. โThatโll do,โ said Breton at last. He dropped his revolver into his pocket and turned to the two old men. Elphick averted his eyes and sank into a chair in the darkest corner of the room: old Cardlestone shook as with palsy and muttered words which the two young men could not catch. โGuardian,โ continued Breton, โdonโt be frightened! And donโt you be frightened, either, Mr. Cardlestone. Thereโs nothing to be afraid of, just yet, whatever there may be later on. It seems to me that Mr. Spargo and I came just in time. Now, guardian, what was this fellow after?โ Old Elphick lifted his head and shook it; he was plainly on the verge of tears; as for Cardlestone, it was evident that his nerve was completely gone. And Breton pointed Spargo to an old corner cupboard. โSpargo,โ he said, โIโm pretty sure youโll find whisky in there. Give them both a stiff dose: theyโve broken up. Now, guardian,โ he continued, when Spargo had carried out this order, โwhat was he after? Shall I suggest it? Was itโblackmail?โ Cardlestone began to whimper; Elphick nodded his head. โYes, yes!โ he muttered. โBlackmail! That was itโblackmail. Heโhe got moneyโpapersโfrom us. Theyโre on him.โ Breton turned on the captive with a look of contempt. โI thought as much, Mr. Myerst,โ he said. โSpargo, letโs see what he has on him. โ Spargo began to search the prisonerโs pockets. He laid out everything on the table as he found it. It was plain that Myerst had contemplated some sort of flight or a long, long journey. There was a quantity of loose gold; a number of bank-notes of the more easily negotiated denominations; various foreign securities, realizable in Paris. And there was an open cheque, signed by Cardlestone for ten thousand pounds, and another, with Elphickโs name at the foot, also open, for half that amount. Breton examined all these matters as Spargo handed them out. He turned to old Elphick. โGuardian,โ he said, โwhy have you or Mr. Cardlestone given this man these cheques and securities? What hold has he on you?โ Old Cardlestone began to whimper afresh; Elphick turned a troubled face on his ward. โHeโhe threatened to accuse us of the murder of Marbury!โ he faltered. โWeโwe didnโt see that we had a chance.โ โWhat does he know of the murder of Marbury and of you in connection with it?โ demanded Breton. โComeโtell me the truth now.โ โHeโs been investigatingโso he says,โ answered Elphick. โHe lives in that house in Middle Temple Lane, you know, in the top-floor rooms above Cardlestoneโs. Andโand he says heโs the fullest evidence against Cardlestoneโand against me as an accessory after the fact.โ โAndโitโs a lie?โ asked Breton. โA lie!โ answered Elphick. โOf course, itโs a lie. Butโheโs so clever thatโthatโโโ โThat you donโt know how you could prove it otherwise,โ said Breton. โAh! And so this fellow lives over Mr. Cardlestone there, does he? That may account for a good many things. Now we must have the police here.โ He sat down at the table and drew the writing materials to him. โLook here, Spargo,โ he continued. โIโm going to write a note to the superintendent of police at Hawesโthereโs a farm half a mile from here where I can get a man to ride down to Hawes with the note. Now, if you want to send a wire to the _Watchman_, draft it out, and heโll take it with him.โ Elphick began to move in his corner. โMust the police come?โ he said. โMustโโโ โThe police must come,โ answered Breton firmly. โGo ahead with your wire, Spargo, while I write this note.โ Three quarters of an hour later, when Breton came back from the farm, he sat down at Elphickโs side and laid his hand on the old manโs. โNow, guardian,โ he said, quietly, โyouโve got to tell us the truth.โ Chapter 35 – Myerst Explains. It had been apparent to Spargo, from the moment of his entering the cottage, that the two old men were suffering badly from shock and fright: Cardlestone still sat in his corner shivering and trembling; he looked incapable of explaining anything; Elphick was scarcely more fitted to speak. And when Breton issued his peremptory invitation to his guardian to tell the truth, Spargo intervened. โFar better leave him alone, Breton,โ he said in a low voice. โDonโt you see the old chapโs done up? Theyโre both done up. We donโt know what theyโve gone through with this fellow before we came, and itโs certain theyโve had no sleep. Leave it all till laterโafter all, weโve found them and weโve found him.โ He jerked his thumb over his shoulder in Myerstโs direction, and Breton involuntarily followed the movement. He caught the prisonerโs eye, and Myerst laughed. โI daresay you two young men think yourselves very clever,โ he said sneeringly. โDonโt you, now?โ โWeโve been clever enough to catch you, anyway,โ retorted Breton. โAnd now weโve got you weโll keep you till the police can relieve us of you.โ โOh!โ said Myerst, with another sneering laugh. โAnd on what charge do you propose to hand me over to the police? It strikes me youโll have some difficulty in formulating one, Mr. Breton.โ โWell see about that later,โ said Breton. โYouโve extorted money by menaces from these gentlemen, at any rate.โ โHave I? How do you know they didnโt entrust me with these cheques as their agent?โ exclaimed Myerst. โAnswer me that! Or, rather, let them answer if they dare. Here you, Cardlestone, you Elphickโdidnโt you give me these cheques as your agent? Speak up now, and quick!โ Spargo, watching the two old men, saw them both quiver at the sound of Myerstโs voice; Cardlestone indeed, began to whimper softly. โLook here, Breton,โ he said, whispering, โthis scoundrelโs got some hold on these two old chapsโtheyโre frightened to death of him. Leave them alone: it would be best for them if they could get some rest. Hold your tongue, you!โ he added aloud, turning to Myerst. โWhen we want you to speak weโll tell you.โ But Myerst laughed again. โAll very high and mighty, Mr. Spargo of the _Watchman_!โ he sneered. โYouโre another of the cock-sure lot. And youโre very clever, but not clever enough. Now, look here! Supposingโโ Spargo turned his back on him. He went over to old Cardlestone and felt his hands. And he turned to Breton with a look of concern. โI say!โ he exclaimed. โHeโs more than frightenedโheโs ill! Whatโs to be done?โ โI asked the police to bring a doctor along with them,โ answered Breton. โIn the meantime, letโs put him to bedโthere are beds in that inner room. Weโll get him to bed and give him something hot to drinkโthatโs all I can think of for the present.โ Between them they managed to get Cardlestone to his bed, and Spargo, with a happy thought, boiled water on the rusty stove and put hot bottles to his feet. When that was done they persuaded Elphick to lie down in the inner room. Presently both old men fell asleep, and then Breton and Spargo suddenly realized that they themselves were hungry and wet and weary. โThere ought to be food in the cupboard,โ said Breton, beginning to rummage. โTheyโve generally had a good stock of tinned things. Here we are, Spargoโthese are tongues and sardines. Make some hot coffee while I open one of these tins.โ The prisoner watched the preparations for a rough and ready breakfast with eyes that eventually began to glisten. โI may remind you that Iโm hungry, too,โ he said as Spargo set the coffee on the table. โAnd youโve no right to starve me, even if youโve the physical ability to keep me tied up. Give me something to eat, if you please.โ โYou shanโt starve,โ said Breton, carelessly. He cut an ample supply of bread and meat, filled a cup with coffee and placed cup and plate before Myerst. โUntie his right arm, Spargo,โ he continued. โI think we can give him that liberty. Weโve got his revolver, anyhow.โ For a while the three men ate and drank in silence. At last Myerst pushed his plate away. He looked scrutinizingly at his two captors. โLook here!โ he said. โYou think you know a lot about all this affair, Spargo, but thereโs only one person who knows all about it. Thatโs me!โ โWeโre taking that for granted,โ said Spargo. โWe guessed as much when we found you here. Youโll have ample opportunity for explanation, you know, later on.โ โIโll explain now, if you care to hear,โ said Myerst with another of his cynical laughs. โAnd if I do, Iโll tell you the truth. I know youโve got an idea in your heads that isnโt favourable to me, but youโre utterly wrong, whatever you may think. Look here!โIโll make you a fair offer. There are some cigars in my case thereโgive me one, and mix me a drink of that whiskyโa good โunโand Iโll tell you what I know about this matter. Come on!โanythingโs better than sitting here doing nothing.โ The two young men looked at each other. Then Breton nodded. โLet him talk if he likes,โ he said. โWeโre not bound to believe him. And we may hear something thatโs true. Give him his cigar and his drink.โ Myerst took a stiff pull at the contents of the tumbler which Spargo presently set before him. He laughed as he inhaled the first fumes of his cigar. โAs it happens, youโll hear nothing but the truth,โ he observed. โNow that things are as they are, thereโs no reason why I shouldnโt tell the truth. The fact is, Iโve nothing to fear. You canโt give me in charge, for it so happens that Iโve got a power of attorney from these two old chaps inside there to act for them in regard to the money they entrusted me with. Itโs in an inside pocket of that letter-case, and if you look at it, Breton, youโll see itโs in order. Iโm not even going to dare you to interfere with or destroy itโyouโre a barrister, and youโll respect the law. But thatโs a factโand if anybodyโs got a case against anybody, I have against you two for assault and illegal detention. But Iโm not a vindictive man, andโโโ Breton took up Myerstโs letter-case and examined its contents. And presently he turned to Spargo. โHeโs right!โ he whispered. โThis is quite in order.โ He turned to Myerst. โAll the same,โ he said, addressing him, โwe shanโt release you, because we believe youโre concerned in the murder of John Marbury. Weโre justified in holding you on that account.โ โAll right, my young friend,โ said Myerst. โHave your own stupid way. But I said Iโd tell you the plain truth. Well, the plain truth is that I know no more of the absolute murder of your father than I know of what is going on in Timbuctoo at this moment! I do not know who killed John Maitland. Thatโs a fact! It may have been the old man in there whoโs already at his own last gasp, or it maynโt. I tell you I donโt knowโthough, like you, Spargo, Iโve tried hard to find out. Thatโs the truthโI do not know.โ โYou expect us to believe that?โ exclaimed Breton incredulously. โBelieve it or not, as you likeโitโs the truth,โ answered Myerst. โNow, look hereโI said nobody knew as much of this affair as I know, and thatโs true also. And hereโs the truth of what I know. The old man in that room, whom you know as Nicholas Cardlestone, is in reality Chamberlayne, the stockbroker, of Market Milcaster, whose name was so freely mentioned when your father was tried there. Thatโs another fact!โ โHow,โ asked Breton, sternly, โcan you prove it? How do you know it?โ โBecause,โ replied Myerst, with a cunning grin, โI helped to carry out his mock death and burialโI was a solicitor in those days, and my name wasโsomething else. There were three of us at it: Chamberlayneโs nephew; a doctor of no reputation; and myself. We carried it out very cleverly, and Chamberlayne gave us five thousand pounds apiece for our trouble. It was not the first time that I had helped him and been well paid for my help. The first time was in connection with the Cloudhampton Hearth and Home Mutual Benefit Society affairโAylmore, or Ainsworth, was as innocent as a child in that!โChamberlayne was the man at the back. But, unfortunately, Chamberlayne didnโt profitโhe lost all he got by it, pretty quick. That was why be transferred his abilities to Market Milcaster.โ โYou can prove all this, I suppose?โ remarked Spargo. โEvery wordโevery letter! But about the Market Milcaster affair: Your father, Breton, was right in what he said about Chamberlayne having all the money that was got from the bank. He hadโand he engineered that mock death and funeral so that he could disappear, and he paid us who helped him generously, as Iโve told you. The thing couldnโt have been better done. When it was done, the nephew disappeared; the doctor disappeared; Chamberlayne disappeared. I had bad luckโto tell you the truth, I was struck off the rolls for a technical offence. So I changed my name and became Mr. Myerst, and eventually what I am now. And it was not until three years ago that I found Chamberlayne. I found him in this way: After I became secretary to the Safe Deposit Company, I took chambers in the Temple, above Cardlestoneโs. And I speedily found out who he was. Instead of going abroad, the old foxโthough he was a comparatively young โun, then!โhad shaved off his beard, settled down in the Temple and given himself up to his two hobbies, collecting curiosities and stamps. There heโd lived quietly all these years, and nobody had ever recognized or suspected him. Indeed, I donโt see how they could; he lived such a quiet, secluded life, with his collections, his old port, and his little whims and fads. ButโI knew him!โ โAnd you doubtless profited by your recognition,โ suggested Breton. โI certainly did. He was glad to pay me a nice sum every quarter to hold my tongue,โ replied Myerst, โand I was glad to take it and, naturally, I gained a considerable knowledge of him. He had only one friendโMr. Elphick, in there. Now, Iโll tell you about him.โ โOnly if you are going to speak respectfully of him,โ said Breton sternly. โIโve no reason to do otherwise. Elphick is the man who ought to have married your mother. When things turned out as they did, Elphick took you and brought you up as he has done, so that you should never know of your fatherโs disgrace. Elphick never knew until last night that Cardlestone is Chamberlayne. Even the biggest scoundrels have friendsโElphickโs very fond of Cardlestone. Heโโโ Spargo turned sharply on Myerst. โYou say Elphick didnโt know until last night!โ he exclaimed. โWhy, then, this running away? What were they running from?โ โI have no more notion than you have, Spargo,โ replied Myerst. โI tell you one or other of them knows something that I donโt. Elphick, I gather, took fright from you, and went to Cardlestoneโthen they both vanished. It may be that Cardlestone did kill MaitlandโI donโt know. But Iโll tell you what I know about the actual murderโfor I do know a good deal about it, though, as I say, I donโt know who killed Maitland. Now, first, you know all that about Maitlandโs having papers and valuables and gold on him? Very wellโIโve got all that. The whole lot is locked upโsafelyโand Iโm willing to hand it over to you, Breton, when we go back to town, and the necessary proof is givenโas it will beโthat youโre Maitlandโs son.โ Myerst paused to see the effect of this announcement, and laughed when he saw the blank astonishment which stole over his hearersโ faces. โAnd still more,โ he continued, โIโve got all the contents of that leather box which Maitland deposited with meโthatโs safely locked up, too, and at your disposal. I took possession of that the day after the murder. Then, for purposes of my own, I went to Scotland Yard, as Spargo there is aware. You see, I was playing a gameโand it required some ingenuity.โ โA game!โ exclaimed Breton. โGood heavensโwhat game?โ โI never knew until I had possession of all these things that Marbury was Maitland of Market Milcaster,โ answered Myerst. โWhen I did know then I began to put things together and to pursue my own line, independent of everybody. I tell you I had all Maitlandโs papers and possessions, by that timeโexcept one thing. That packet of Australian stamps. AndโI found out that those stamps were in the hands ofโCardlestone!โ Chapter 36 – The Final Telegram. Myerst paused, to take a pull at his glass, and to look at the two amazed listeners with a smile of conscious triumph. โIn the hands of Cardlestone,โ he repeated. โNow, what did I argue from that? Why, of course, that Maitland had been to Cardlestoneโs rooms that night. Wasnโt he found lying dead at the foot of Cardlestoneโs stairs? Ayeโbut who found him? Not the porterโnot the policeโnot you, Master Spargo, with all your cleverness. The man who found Maitland lying dead there that night wasโI!โ In the silence that followed, Spargo, who had been making notes of what Myerst said, suddenly dropped his pencil and thrusting his hands in his pockets sat bolt upright with a look which Breton, who was watching him seriously, could not make out. It was the look of a man whose ideas and conceptions are being rudely upset. And Myerst, too, saw it and he laughed, more sneeringly than ever. โThatโs one for you, Spargo!โ he said. โThat surprises youโthat makes you think. Now what do you think?โif one may ask.โ โI think,โ said Spargo, โthat you are either a consummate liar, or that this mystery is bigger than before.โ โI can lie when itโs necessary,โ retorted Myerst. โJust now it isnโt necessary. Iโm telling you the plain truth: thereโs no reason why I shouldnโt. As Iโve said before, although you two young bullies have tied me up in this fashion, you canโt do anything against me. Iโve a power of attorney from those two old men in there, and thatโs enough to satisfy anybody as to my possession of their cheques and securities. Iโve the whip hand of you, my sons, in all ways. And thatโs why Iโm telling you the truthโto amuse myself during this period of waiting. The plain truth, my sons!โ โIn pursuance of which,โ observed Breton, drily, โI think you mentioned that you were the first person to find my father lying dead?โ โI was. That isโas far as I can gather. Iโll tell you all about it. As I said, I live over Cardlestone. That night I came home very lateโit was well past one oโclock. There was nobody aboutโas a matter of fact, no one has residential chambers in that building but Cardlestone and myself. I found the body of a man lying in the entry. I struck a match and immediately recognized my visitor of the afternoonโJohn Marbury. Now, although I was so late in going home, I was as sober as a man can be, and I think pretty quickly at all times. I thought at double extra speed just then. And the first thing I did was to strip the body of every article it had on itโmoney, papers, everything. All these things are safely locked upโtheyโve never been tracked. Next day, using my facilities as secretary to the Safe Deposit Company, I secured the things in that box. Then I found out who the dead man really was. And then I deliberately set to work to throw dust in the eyes of the police and of the newspapers, and particularly in the eyes of young Master Spargo there. I had an object.โ โWhat?โ asked Breton. โWhat! Knowing all I did, I firmly believed that Marbury, or, rather, Maitland, had been murdered by either Cardlestone or Elphick. I put it to myself in this way, and my opinion was strengthened as you, Spargo, inserted news in your paperโMaitland, finding himself in the vicinity of Cardlestone after leaving Aylmoreโs rooms that night, turned into our building, perhaps just to see where Cardlestone lived. He met Cardlestone accidentally, or he perhaps met Cardlestone and Elphick togetherโthey recognized each other. Maitland probably threatened to expose Cardlestone, or, rather, Chamberlayneโnobody, of course, could know what happened, but my theory was that Chamberlayne killed him. There, at any rate, was the fact that Maitland was found murdered at Chamberlayneโs very threshold. And, in the course of a few days, I proved, to my own positive satisfaction, by getting access to Chamberlayneโs rooms in his absence that Maitland had been there, had been in those rooms. For I found there, in Chamberlayneโs desk, the rare Australian stamps of which Criedir told at the inquest. That was proof positive.โ Spargo looked at Breton. They knew what Myerst did not knowโthat the stamps of which he spoke were lying in Spargoโs breast pocket, where they had lain since he had picked them up from the litter and confusion of Chamberlayneโs floor. โWhy,โ asked Breton, after a pause, โwhy did you never accuse Cardlestone, or Chamberlayne, of the murder?โ โI did! I have accused him a score of timesโand Elphick, too,โ replied Myerst with emphasis. โNot at first, mind youโI never let Chamberlayne know that I ever suspected him for some time. I had my own game to play. But at lastโnot so many days agoโI did. I accused them both. Thatโs how I got the whip hand of them. They began to be afraidโby that time Elphick had got to know all about Cardlestoneโs past as Chamberlayne. And as I tell you, Elphickโs fond of Cardlestone. Itโs queer, but he is. Heโwants to shield him.โ โWhat did they say when you accused them?โ asked Breton. โLetโs keep to that pointโnever mind their feelings for one another.โ โJust so, but that feelingโs a lot more to do with this mystery than you think, my young friend,โ said Myerst. โWhat did they say, you ask? Why, they strenuously denied it, Cardlestone swore solemnly to me that he had no part or lot in the murder of Maitland. So did Elphick. Butโthey know something about the murder. If those two old men canโt tell you definitely who actually struck John Maitland down, Iโm certain that they have a very clear idea in their minds as to who really did! Theyโโ A sudden sharp cry from the inner room interrupted Myerst. Breton and Spargo started to their feet and made for the door. But before they could reach it Elphick came out, white and shaking. โHeโs gone!โ he exclaimed in quavering accents. โMy old friendโs goneโheโs dead! I wasโasleep. I woke suddenly and looked at him. Heโโโ Spargo forced the old man into a chair and gave him some whisky; Breton passed quickly into the inner room; only to come back shaking his head. โHeโs dead,โ he said. โHe evidently died in his sleep.โ โThen his secretโs gone with him,โ remarked Myerst, calmly. โAnd now we shall never know if he did kill John Maitland or if he didnโt. So thatโs done with!โ Old Elphick suddenly sat up in his chair, pushing Spargo fiercely away from his side. โHe didnโt kill John Maitland!โ he cried angrily, attempting to shake his fist at Myerst. โWhoever says he killed Maitland lies. He was as innocent as I am. Youโve tortured and tormented him to his death with that charge, as youโre torturing meโamong you. I tell you heโd nothing to do with John Maitlandโs deathโnothing!โ Myerst laughed. โWho had, then?โ he said. โHold your tongue!โ commanded Breton, turning angrily on him. He sat down by Elphickโs side and laid his hand soothingly on the old manโs arm. โGuardian,โ he said, โwhy donโt you tell what you know? Donโt be afraid of that fellow thereโheโs safe enough. Tell Spargo and me what you know of the matter. Remember, nothing can hurt Cardlestone, or Chamberlayne, or whoever he is or was, now.โ Elphick sat for a moment shaking his head. He allowed Spargo to give him another drink; he lifted his head and looked at the two young men with something of an appeal. โIโm badly shaken,โ he said. โIโve suffered much latelyโIโve learnt things that I didnโt know. Perhaps I ought to have spoken before, but I was afraid forโfor him. He was a good friend, Cardlestone, whatever else he may have beenโa good friend. AndโI donโt know any more than what happened that night.โ โTell us what happened that night,โ said Breton. โWell, that night I went round, as I often did, to play piquet with Cardlestone. That was about ten oโclock. About eleven Jane Baylis came to Cardlestoneโsโsheโd been to my rooms to find meโwanted to see me particularlyโand sheโd come on there, knowing where I should be. Cardlestone would make her have a glass of wine and a biscuit; she sat down and we all talked. Then, about, I should think, a quarter to twelve, a knock came at Cardlestoneโs doorโhis outer door was open, and of course anybody outside could see lights within. Cardlestone went to the door: we heard a manโs voice enquire for him by name; then the voice added that Criedir, the stamp dealer, had advised him to call on Mr. Cardlestone to show him some rare Australian stamps, and that seeing a light under his door he had knocked. Cardlestone asked him inโhe came in. That was the man we saw next day at the mortuary. Upon my honour, we didnโt know him, either that night or next day!โ โWhat happened when he came in?โ asked Breton. โCardlestone asked him to sit down: he offered and gave him a drink. The man said Criedir had given him Cardlestoneโs address, and that heโd been with a friend at some rooms in Fountain Court, and as he was passing our building heโd just looked to make sure where Cardlestone lived, and as heโd noticed a light heโd made bold to knock. He and Cardlestone began to examine the stamps. Jane Baylis said good-night, and she and I left Cardlestone and the man together.โ โNo one had recognized him?โ said Breton. โNo one! Remember, I only once or twice saw Maitland in all my life. The others certainly did not recognize him. At least, I never knew that they didโif they did.โ โTell us,โ said Spargo, joining in for the first time, โtell us what you and Miss Baylis did?โ โAt the foot of the stairs Jane Baylis suddenly said sheโd forgotten something in Cardlestoneโs lobby. As she was going out in to Fleet Street, and I was going down Middle Temple Lane to turn off to my own rooms we said good-night. She went back upstairs. And I went home. And upon my soul and honour thatโs all I know!โ Spargo suddenly leapt to his feet. He snatched at his capโa sodden and bedraggled headgear which he had thrown down when they entered the cottage. โThatโs enough!โ he almost shouted. โIโve got itโat last! Bretonโwhereโs the nearest telegraph office? Hawes? Straight down this valley? Then, hereโs for it! Look after things till Iโm back, or, when the police come, join me there. I shall catch the first train to town, anyhow, after wiring.โ โButโwhat are you after, Spargo?โ exclaimed Breton. โStop! What on earthโโโ But Spargo had closed the door and was running for all he was worth down the valley. Three quarters of an hour later he startled a quiet and peaceful telegraphist by darting, breathless and dirty, into a sleepy country post office, snatching a telegraph form and scribbling down a message in shaky handwriting:โ _Rathbury, New Scotland Yard, London._ _Arrest Jane Baylis at once for murder of John Maitland._ _Coming straight to town with full evidence._ _Frank Spargo_. Then Spargo dropped on the office bench, and while the wondering operator set the wires ticking, strove to get his breath, utterly spent in his mad race across the heather. And when it was got he set out againโto find the station. Some days later, Spargo, having seen Stephen Aylmore walk out of the Bow Street dock, cleared of the charge against him, and in a fair way of being cleared of the affair of twenty years before, found himself in a very quiet corner of the Court holding the hand of Jessie Aylmore, who, he discovered, was saying things to him which he scarcely comprehended. There was nobody near them and the girl spoke freely and warmly. โBut you will comeโyou will come todayโand be properly thanked,โ she said. โYou willโwonโt you?โ Spargo allowed himself to retain possession of the hand. Also he took a straight look into Jessie Aylmoreโs eyes. โI donโt want thanks,โ he said. โIt was all a lot of luck. And if I comeโtodayโit will be to seeโjust you!โ Jessie Aylmore looked down at the two hands. โI think,โ she whispered, โI think that is what I really meant!โ Thank you for joining us on this journey through ‘The Middle Temple Murder’ by J. S. Fletcher. We hope you enjoyed the mystery and suspense that kept us on the edge of our seats. If you enjoyed the story, don’t forget to like, comment, and subscribe for more thrilling tales from the world of classic literature. Until next time, keep the curiosity alive, and we look forward to sharing more captivating stories with you here on Storytime Haven.
Welcome to Storytime Haven! Today, we bring you a thrilling dive into the world of crime and intrigue with **’The Middle Temple Murder’ by J. S. Fletcher**. Set in the heart of London, this classic detective novel uncovers the mysteries surrounding a gruesome murder in a secluded alley. Join reporter Spargo as he investigates the dark corners of the city, uncovering secrets, deception, and an intricate web of suspects. Will he crack the case before it’s too late? ๐ต๏ธโโ๏ธ๐ผ
**Story Overview**:
๐ช **The Murder**: A man is found dead in a mysterious alley, his body surrounded by strange clues that don’t add up.
๐ **The Detective**: Spargo, a determined reporter with an eye for detail, becomes entangled in a complex investigation that leads him to the most unexpected places.
๐ฐ๏ธ **The Setting**: London in the early 20th century, where secrets are hidden beneath the fog and every corner may hold a deadly truth.
**Why You Should Watch**:
– Engaging plot with suspenseful twists and turns.
– A mix of detective work, crime, and psychological drama.
– Classic storytelling by J. S. Fletcher, a master of the genre.
– Perfect for lovers of mystery, crime fiction, and historical novels.
๐ฌ **Join the Conversation**:
– **What do you think of the clues so far?** ๐ง Leave your thoughts and theories in the comments!
– **Enjoyed the story?** Don’t forget to **LIKE**, **SUBSCRIBE**, and **SHARE** this mystery with friends and fellow book lovers!
๐ **Stay Updated**: For more gripping mysteries, classics, and in-depth storytelling, **subscribe now**
(https://bit.ly/StorytimeHavenOfficial)
-Other People’s Money ๐ฐ๐ | A Tale of Intrigue and Deception [https://youtu.be/Ty_WRw4A8Nc]
-The Dalehouse Murder ๐ต๏ธโโ๏ธ๐ A Classic Mystery Novel by Francis Everton [https://youtu.be/CRSrdVT9-J0]
-Lady Molly of Scotland Yard ๐ต๏ธโโ๏ธ๐ A Thrilling Mystery by Baroness Orczy (https://youtu.be/iqk1bdxgxfQ)
-๐ต๏ธโโ๏ธ Room 13 by Edgar Wallace ๐ A Mystery That Defies Logic! (https://youtu.be/6Ke40FuHGyY)
-Captain Blood โ๏ธ A Swashbuckling Pirate Adventure by Rafael Sabatini (https://youtu.be/m1L8rFgAUgo)
– ๐ The Brooklyn Murders | A Gripping Mystery by G. D. H. Cole ๐ต๏ธโโ๏ธ (https://youtu.be/hxETC8UMHls)
-The Four-Fingered Glove; Or, The Cost of a Lie ๐ต๏ธโโ๏ธ๐ผ Mystery & Deception! (https://youtu.be/xd4cmygl4j8)
-๐ Knock, Knock, Knock and Other Stories ๐ | Ivan Turgenev’s Haunting Tales ๐ญ (https://youtu.be/1oy3o8oLPgI)
๐ The Mystery of 31 New Inn ๐จ (https://youtu.be/zrdRhAyszt4)
๐ The Blue Castle by L. M. Montgomery | A Tale of Love & Freedom ๐โจ (https://youtu.be/nM3YR4cXHmc)
– ๐โจ Call Mr. Fortune: A Classic Detective Mystery by H. C. Bailey | Full Story โจ๐ (https://youtu.be/cR36exYi72c)
-๐ต๏ธโโ๏ธ The Scarlet Bat: A Detective Story ๐ | A Gripping Mystery by Fergus Hume [https://youtu.be/8nXt_IMhSLE]
**Hashtags**:
#mystery #crimefiction #detective #booklover #historicalfiction #J.S.Fletcher #murdermystery #classicliterature #detectivefiction #whodunit #storytimehaven #bookcommunity #classicnovels #fictionalcrimes #booktube #audiobook #mysterynovel #detectivestory #crimeinvestigation #classicmystery #suspensefiction #detectivepuzzle #literarythriller #bookreview #thrillerbooks #crimebooks #suspenseful
**#SubscribeNow** to keep up with more thrilling classics and mysteries like this one!
**Navigate by Chapters or Titles:**
00:00:35 Chapter 1 – The Scrap of Grey Paper.
00:12:44 Chapter 2 – His First Brief.
00:24:51 Chapter 3 – The Clue of the Cap.
00:37:21 Chapter 4 – The Anglo-Orient Hotel.
00:49:31 Chapter 5 – Spargo Wishes to Specialize.
01:01:27 Chapter 6 – Witness to a Meeting.
01:14:13 Chapter 7 – Mr. Aylmore.
01:27:03 Chapter 8 – The Man from the Safe Deposit.
01:39:54 Chapter 9 – The Dealer in Rare Stamps.
01:51:52 Chapter 10 – The Leather Box.
02:04:18 Chapter 11 – Mr. Aylmore is Questioned.
02:05:06 noting how each successive witness contributed, as it were, a chapter
02:16:09 Chapter 12 – The New Witness.
02:26:02 Chapter 13 – Under Suspicion.
02:35:40 Chapter 14 – The Silver Ticket.
02:48:03 Chapter 15 – Market Milcaster.
03:00:59 Chapter 16 – The ‘Yellow Dragon’.
03:14:05 Chapter 17 – Mr. Quarterpage Harks Back.
03:27:20 Chapter 18 – An Old Newspaper.
03:38:31 Chapter 19 – The Chamberlayne Story.
03:51:20 Chapter 20 – Maitland alias Marbury.
04:03:02 Chapter 21 – Arrested.
04:14:37 Chapter 22 – The Blank Past.
04:26:19 Chapter 23 – Miss Baylis.
04:36:18 Chapter 24 – Mother Gutch.
04:47:26 Chapter 25 – Revelations.
04:58:43 Chapter 26 – Still Silent.
05:09:30 Chapter 27 – Mr. Elphick’s Chambers.
05:20:22 Chapter 28 – Of Proved Identity.
05:32:14 Chapter 29 – The Closed Doors.
05:44:21 Chapter 30 – Revelation.
05:56:09 Chapter 31 – The Penitent Window-Cleaner.
06:06:43 Chapter 32 – The Contents of the Coffin.
06:18:22 Chapter 33 – Forestalled.
06:30:36 Chapter 34 – The Whip Hand.
06:41:52 Chapter 35 – Myerst Explains.
06:54:47 Chapter 36 – The Final Telegram.
2ไปถใฎใณใกใณใ
๐ง Enjoying the audiobook? ๐ Please like, share, subscribe and comment! ๐โจ
4:32:00. ๐